File:01unpir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:22 1997
[PI00600(R)03/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0090101-C
File:01unpir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:22 1997
*[PI00800(R)03/96]
thirty-six pica chart:
File:01unpir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:22 1997
*[PI02300(R)05/95]
Table of Contents
Introduction
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1
Instrumentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Controls and Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Seating and Safety Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
101
Starting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
147
Driving
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
155
Roadside Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
217
Maintainance and Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
249
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
311
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
315
Customer Assistance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
317
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
327
Quick Index
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
331
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
343
Service Station Information
364
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
Introduction
*[II00300(R)01/96]
*[II00400(R)01/96]
Ford’s Commitment to You
*[II00500(R)01/96]
*[II00600(R)01/96]
Our Guiding Principles
*[II00700(R)01/96]
■ You are the focus of everything we do. Our work must be
*[II00750(R)01/96]
■ Continuous improvement is essential to our success. We
*[II00800(R)01/96]
■ Employee involvement is our way of life. We are a team.
*[II00900(R)01/96]
■ Dealers and suppliers are our partners. We must maintain
*[II01000(R)01/96]
■ Integrity is never compromised. Our conduct worldwide
At Ford Motor Company, excellence is the continuous
commitment to achieve the best result possible. It is dedication
to learning what you want, determination to develop the right
concept, and execution of that concept with care, precision, and
attention to detail. In short, excellence means being the standard
by which others are judged.
■ Quality comes first. For your satisfaction, the quality of our
products and services must be our number one priority.
done with you in mind, providing better products and
services than our competition.
must strive for excellence in everything we do: in our
products — in their safety and value — and in our services,
our human relations, our competitiveness, and our
profitability.
We must treat one another with trust and respect.
mutually beneficial relationships with dealers, suppliers, and
our other business associates.
must be pursued in a manner that is socially responsible and
commands respect for its integrity and for its positive
contributions to society.
1
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
*[II01010(R)03/96]
*[II01020(R)03/96]
Things to Know About Using This Guide
*[II01030(R)03/96]
This guide describes equipment and gives specifications for
equipment that was in effect when this guide was approved for
printing. Ford may discontinue models or change specifications
or design without any notice and without incurring obligation.
*[II01040(R)03/96]
*[II01042(R)02/96]
NOTES and WARNINGS
*[II01044(R)01/96]
WARNINGS remind you to be especially careful in those areas
where carelessness can cause damage to your vehicle or
personal injury to yourself, your passengers or other people.
Please read all WARNINGS carefully.
Congratulations on the purchase of your new vehicle. This
guide has information about the equipment and the options for
your new vehicle. You may not have bought all of the options
available to you. If you do not know which information applies
to your vehicle, talk to your dealer.
NOTES give you additional information about the subject
matter you are referencing.
*[II01046(R)01/96]
R WARNING
*[II01050(R)01/96]
*[II01060(R)01/96]
Finding Information in This Guide
*[II01070(R)03/96]
The Quick Index at the end of the book provides a page
number following each item which indicates where detailed
information can be found.
After you have read this guide once, you will probably return
to it when you have a specific question or need additional
information. To help you find specific information quickly, you
can use the Quick Index, Table of Contents, or the Index.
2
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
Introduction
*[II01080(R)01/96]
To use the Index, turn to the back of the book and search in the
alphabetical listing for the word that best describes the
information you need. If the word you chose is not listed, think
of other related words and look them up. We have designed the
Index so that you can find information under a technical term.
*[II01090(R)01/96]
*[II01100(R)01/96]
Canadian Owners — French Version
%
%
*[II02400(R)01/96]
French Owner Guides can be obtained from your dealer or by
writing to Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited, Service
Publications, P.O. Box 1580, Station B, Mississauga, Ontario L4Y
4G3.
Your Maintenance Schedule and Record
Booklet
*[II02500(R)03/96]
The Maintenance Schedule booklet lists the services that are most
important for keeping your vehicle in good condition. A record
log is also provided to help you keep track of all services
performed.
*[II02600(R)01/96]
*[II02700(R)01/96]
About the Warranties
%
%
*[II03100(R)01/96]
*[II03250(R)03/96]
Your vehicle is covered by three types of warranties: Basic
Vehicle Warranty, Extended Warranties on certain parts, and
Emissions Warranties.
Read your Warranty Information Booklet carefully to find out
about your vehicle’s warranties and your basic rights and
responsibilities.
If you lose your Warranty Information Booklet, you can get a new
one free of charge. Contact any Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer,
or refer to the addresses and phone numbers on the first page
of this Owner’s Guide.
3
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
*[II04000(R)05/96]
*[II04100(R)05/96]
*[II04120(R)05/96]
Ford Extended Service Plan
*[II04140(R)05/96]
Ford ESP is an optional service contract, backed and
administered by Ford. It provides:
*[II04160(R)05/96]
■ protection against repair costs after your Bumper to Bumper
%
*[II04180(R)05/96]
*[II04200(R)05/96]
More Protection for Your Vehicle
You can get more protection for your new car or light truck by
purchasing a Ford Extended Service Plan (Ford ESP). Ford ESP
is the only extended service program with the Ford name on it
and the only service contract backed by Ford Motor Company.
Warranty expires;
and
■ other benefits during the warranty period (such as:
reimbursement for rentals; coverage for certain maintenance
and wear items).
*[II04220(R)05/96]
You may purchase Ford ESP from any participating Ford Motor
Company dealer. There are several Ford ESP plans available in
various time-and-mileage combinations. Each plan can be
tailored to fit your own driving needs, including reimbursement
benefits for towing and rental. (In Hawaii, rules vary. See your
dealer for details.)
*[II04240(R)05/96]
When you purchase Ford ESP, you receive peace-of-mind
protection throughout the United States and Canada, provided
by a network of more than 5,100 participating Ford Motor
Company dealers.
*[II04260(R)05/96]
NOTE: Repairs performed outside the United States and
Canada are not eligible for ESP coverage.
*[II04280(R)05/96]
This information is subject to change. Ask your dealer for
complete details about Ford ESP coverage.
4
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
Introduction
*[II04650(R)03/96]
% [II04750(R)01/96]
*
%
%
*[II04800(R)05/96]
% [II04850(R)04/96]
[II04875(R)04/96]
Special Notice
NOTICE TO OWNERS OF FOUR-WHEEL
DRIVE VEHICLES
As with other vehicles of this type, failure to operate this
vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an accident. Be
sure to read the Additional Special Driving Instructions for
Four-Wheel Drive Vehicle Operators in this book and the special
supplement included with four-wheel drive vehicles entitled
4-Wheeling.
AMBULANCE PACKAGES
R WARNING
Do not use this vehicle as an ambulance.
*[II06000(R)01/96]
*[II06100(R)01/96]
%
%
*[II06300(R)01/96]
Breaking Your Vehicle In
Your new vehicle goes through an adjustment or break-in
period during the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) that you drive it.
During the break-in period, you need to pay careful attention to
how you drive your vehicle.
■ Avoid sudden stops. Because your vehicle has new brake
linings, you should take these steps:
*[II06400(R)01/96]
— Watch traffic carefully so that you can anticipate when to
stop.
*[II06500(R)01/96]
*[II06600(R)01/96]
*[II06700(R)01/96]
— Begin braking well in advance.
— Apply the brakes gradually.
The break-in period for new brake linings lasts for 100 miles
(160 km) of city driving or 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of
highway driving.
5
File:02uniir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:48:31 1997
*[II06750(R)03/96]
%
*[II06800(R)03/96]
*[II07000(R)01/96]
■ Wheel lug nuts must be retightened to proper torque
specifications at 500 miles/800 km of new vehicle operation.
Proper torque specifications are provided in this guide. Also
retighten to proper torque specifications at 500 miles/800 km
after any wheel change or any other time the wheel lug nuts
have been loosened.
■ Use only the type of engine oil that Ford recommends. See
Engine oil recommendations in the Index. Do not use special
“break-in” oils.
Some vehicles are equipped with a Powertrain Control Module
that limits engine speeds with a cut-out mode to promote
durability.
6
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
%
*[IS00400(R)01/96]
*[IS00500(R)03/96]
*[IS00600(R)03/96]
*[IS00700(R)03/96]
*[IS00900(R)03/96]
The instrument panel (dashboard) on your vehicle is divided
into several different sections. The illustrations on the following
pages show the major parts of the instrument panel that are
described in this chapter. Some items shown may not be on all
vehicles.
Your vehicle has one of the following instrument clusters:
■ A standard instrument cluster
■ A optional instrument cluster with tachometer
If you are not sure which cluster your vehicle has, check the
diagrams on the following pages of this section.
7
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS02500(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090106-D
Instrument Cluster
8
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS02600(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica art:0090107-E
Instrument cluster with tachometer
Instrumentation
9
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
*[IS03000(R)01/96]
*[IS03100(R)01/96]
The Mechanical Cluster
*[IS03200(R)01/96]
*[IS03300(R)03/96]
Brake System Warning Light
*[IS03400(R)03/96]
This light illuminates when you turn the ignition key to START
to verify that the indicator bulb is working. If the light stays on
or illuminates after you have released the parking brake fully,
have the hydraulic brake system serviced.
%
%
The following warning lights and gauges are on the mechanical
cluster. All of the warning lights and gauges alert you to
possible problems with your vehicle. Some of the lights listed
are optional. The following sections detail what each of these
indicators means.
The warning light for the brakes can show two things — that
the parking brake is not fully released, or that the brake fluid
level is low in the master cylinder reservoir. If the fluid level is
low, the brake system should be checked by your dealer or a
qualified service technician.
*[IS03500(R)03/96]
R WARNING
The BRAKE light indicates that the brakes may not be
working properly. Have the brakes checked immediately.
[IS03600(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021145-A
Brake warning light symbols
10
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
*[IS03800(R)01/96]
Anti-lock Brake Warning Light
[IS03925(R)01/96]
To check the ABS brake warning light, turn the ignition key to
ON. The ABS brake warning light should glow momentarily.
[IS03985(R)01/96]
NOTE: If the ABS brake warning light does not glow
momentarily, have your vehicle’s electrical system
checked immediately. If the light begins to flash in a
repeatable flash sequence, check the anti-lock system
continuous power fuse and brakelamps for proper
operation.
[IS04050(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021146-A
Anti-lock warning light symbol
*[IS04100(R)03/96]
R WARNING
If the anti-lock brake system warning light remains on or
comes on while driving, have the braking system checked
by a qualified service technician as soon as possible.
*[IS04110(R)03/96]
%
*[IS04150(R)03/96]
NOTE: If a fault occurs in the anti-lock system, and the brake
warning light is not lit, the anti-lock system is
disabled but normal brake function remains
operational.
Safety Belt Warning Light and Chime
[IS04301(R)04/96]
The safety belt warning light/chime reminds you to fasten your
safety belt. One of the following will take place:
[IS04325(R)05/96]
■ If the safety belt is not buckled before the key is turned to
the ON position, the light comes on for one to two minutes
and the chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
11
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
*[IS04351(R)03/96]
■ If the safety belt is buckled while the light is on and the
[IS04355(R)01/96]
■ If safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON
chime is sounding, both the light and chime turn off.
position, both the light and the chime will not turn on.
[IS04400(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021148-B
Safety belt warning light symbol
%
*[IS04420(R)03/96]
[IS04430(R)01/96]
Air Bag Readiness Light
This light illuminates for approximately six seconds when the
ignition key is turned to the ON position to verify that the
indicator bulb is working and the air bag system is operating
normally.
[IS04435(R)01/96]
R WARNING
A problem with the air bag system is indicated by one or
more of the following: the readiness light will either
flash or stay lit, or it will not light, or a group of five
beeps will be heard.
*[IS04437(R)05/96]
R WARNING
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have
the air bag system serviced at your Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealer immediately.
12
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
[IS04440(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021268-A
Air bag readiness light symbol
[IS04443(R)05/96]
Passenger Air Bag OFF Light (If equipped)
[IS04444(R)01/96]
The passenger air bag OFF light is located in the lower center of
the instrument panel next to the passenger air bag defeat
switch. This yellow indicator light illuminates whenever the
passenger air bag is turned off and the ignition is on. The
passenger air bag should be turned off only when a rear-facing
infant seat is installed in the front passenger seat.
[IS04450(R)01/96]
Door Ajar Warning Light (If equipped)
*[IS04460(R)01/96]
If the ignition switch is in the ON position and any door or the
liftgate is not completely closed, the light will illuminate.
[IS04480(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021269-A
Door ajar warning light symbol
13
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
%
*[IS04500(R)03/96]
[IS04600(R)05/96]
Check Engine Warning Light
This light illuminates when the engine’s Emission Control
System requires service. It will also illuminate when the ignition
key is in the ON position and the engine is off.
[IS05300(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021149-A
Check engine warning light symbol
% [IS05835(R)05/96]
Transmission Control Indicator Light (TCIL)
[IS05850(R)05/96]
The TCIL tells you that the Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
on the gearshift lever has been pushed. When the light
illuminates, the transmission does not shift into j (Overdrive).
Depressing the TCS on the shifter once more returns the vehicle
to j (Overdrive). The transmission will be in j (Overdrive)
when the vehicle is started even if the O/D OFF mode was
selected when the vehicle was last shut off.
[IS05855(R)05/96]
NOTE: If the TCIL does not come on when the TCS is
depressed or if the TCIL flashes when you are driving
a malfunction has been detected. Have your vehicle
serviced at the first opportunity. If this condition
persists, damage could occur to the transmission.
[IS05865(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0021226-B
Transmission control indicator light (if equipped)
14
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
*[IS05900(R)01/96]
*[IS06000(R)04/96]
%
Charging System Light
This light indicates that your battery is not being charged and
that you need to have the electrical system checked.
[IS06100(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021150-B
Charging system light symbol
*[IS06200(R)03/96]
This light illuminates every time you turn the ignition to the
ON or START position (engine off). The light should go off
when the engine starts and the alternator begins to charge.
*[IS06300(R)03/96]
If the light stays on or illuminates when the engine is running,
have the electrical system checked as soon as possible.
[IS06700(R)01/96]
Check Gage Light (If equipped)
[IS06800(R)04/96]
This light will come on when the key is in the ON position and
the:
[IS06900(R)01/96]
■ engine coolant temperature is high
[IS07000(R)01/96]
■ engine oil pressure is low
[IS07100(R)01/96]
■ fuel level is near empty
[IS07200(R)01/96]
This light serves as a notice that a system needs your attention
and to check the engine coolant temperature gauge, the engine
oil pressure gauge, and the fuel level gauge.
15
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS07300(R)01/96]
Please see Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge, Engine Oil Pressure
Gauge, or Fuel Gauge in this chapter for more information.
[IS07400(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021250-B
Check gage light
[IS07500(R)01/96]
Fuel Reset Light (If Equipped)
[IS07600(R)01/96]
Your vehicle may have a fuel reset light. The fuel reset light
will come on when you turn the ignition key to ON and the
fuel pump shut-off switch has been triggered. Refer to Fuel
pump shut-off switch in the Index to find additional information.
[IS07700(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021372-A
Fuel reset light
[IS07710(R)05/96]
Speed Control Light (If equipped)
[IS07720(R)05/96]
The SPEED CONT light will illuminate in the instrument cluster
when the speed control system is engaged. The light will turn
off when the brake pedal is pressed or if the speed control is
shut off.
[IS07730(R)05/96]
This display does not indicate any problems with the speed
control, but is simply a convenient way of knowing when speed
control is activated.
16
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
[IS07735(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0090108-A
Speed control light
[IS07740(R)05/96]
Anti-Theft Light (If equipped)
[IS07750(R)05/96]
The THEFT light flashes on and off when the ignition switch is
OFF and any door is opened. As soon as you lock the doors,
the light illuminates steadily. Within 30 seconds of closing all
the doors, the light flashes intermittently (every 2 seconds). This
indicates that the anti-theft system is armed. Refer to Anti-Theft
System in the Index for additional information.
[IS07760(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0021151-B
Anti-theft indicator light
17
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS07770(R)05/96]
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Light (If equipped)
[IS07780(R)05/96]
The 4WD light illuminates when the ignition is ON and the
transfer case is placed in either the 4H (lever-operated system)
or 4WD LOW (electric shift system) positions. Both the 4WD
light and the 4WD LOW light will illuminate when the transfer
case is in the 4L position (lever-operated system) or the 4WD
LOW position (Electric shift system). Refer to Four-Wheel Drive
(4WD) System in the Driving chapter for more information.
[IS07790(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0090222-A
Four-wheel drive indicator light
% [IS07800(R)05/96]
Four-Wheel Drive Low Range Indicator Light
(If equipped)
[IS07810(R)05/96]
The 4WD LOW light illuminates when the ignition is ON and
the transfer case is placed in the 4L position (lever-operated
system) or the 4WD LOW position (electric shift system). Refer
to Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) System in the Driving chapter for
more information.
[IS07820(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0090223-A
Four-wheel drive low range indicator light
18
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
*[IS07830(R)05/96]
*[IS07900(R)04/96]
Battery Voltage Gauge (Voltmeter)
*[IS08000(R)04/96]
If the battery is operating under cold weather conditions, the
pointer may indicate in the upper range of the NORMAL band
while the battery is charging. If you are running electrical
accessories with the engine off or idling at a low speed, or the
battery is not fully charged, the pointer may move toward the
lower end of the NORMAL band.
*[IS08100(R)04/96]
If it stays outside the NORMAL band, have your vehicle’s
electrical system checked as soon as it is safely possible.
%
This gauge shows you the battery voltage when the ignition key
is in the ON position.
[IS08200(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020051-F
Battery voltage gauge — mechanical cluster
[IS08300(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020539-H
Battery voltage gauge — mechanical cluster with tachometer
19
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
*[IS08400(R)04/96]
*[IS08500(R)01/96]
Engine Oil Pressure Gauge
*[IS08600(R)05/96]
*[IS08700(R)04/96]
*[IS08800(R)03/96]
If you lose engine oil pressure:
%
This gauge indicates the engine’s oil pressure, not the oil level.
However, if your engine’s oil level is low, it could affect the oil
pressure. With the engine running, the pointer should move into
the NORMAL band. If the pointer drops below the NORMAL
band while the engine is running, you have lost oil pressure
and continued operation will cause severe engine damage.
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible.
2. Turn off the engine. If you do not stop the engine as soon as
safely possible, severe engine damage could result.
*[IS08900(R)01/96]
3. Check the engine’s oil level, following the instructions on
*[IS09000(R)01/96]
4. If the level is low, add only as much oil as necessary before
checking and adding engine oil. Refer to Engine oil in the
Index. If you do not follow these instructions, you or others
could be injured. To assure an accurate reading, your vehicle
should be on level ground.
you start the engine again. Do not overfill. Do not operate
the engine if the pointer is below the NORMAL band,
regardless of the oil level. Contact your nearest dealer for
further service actions.
[IS09100(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020056-E
Engine oil pressure gauge — mechanical cluster
20
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
[IS09200(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020540-E
Engine oil pressure gauge — mechanical cluster with tachometer
*[IS09300(R)05/96]
*[IS09350(R)01/96]
%
High Beam Light
This light comes on when the headlamps are turned on high
beam or when you flash the lights. If your vehicle is equipped
with daytime running lights and you have your headlamps on,
your high beam light will not illuminate when you flash the
lights.
[IS09400(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021266-A
High beam indicator light symbol
%
*[IS09500(R)03/96]
“Headlamps On” Alert Chime
[IS09510(R)01/96]
This chime sounds if you open the driver’s door while the
headlamps or parking lamps are on, and the key is removed
from the ignition.
*[IS09550(R)03/96]
*[IS09570(R)05/96]
Ignition Key Buzzer or Chime
%
The buzzer or chime will sound if you open the driver’s door
while the key is in the ignition and in the OFF, LOCK, or
ACCESSORY position. Never leave your vehicle unattended
with the key in the ignition.
21
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
*[IS09600(R)05/96]
*[IS09700(R)01/96]
Fuel Gauge
*[IS09850(R)01/96]
For a proper fuel gauge indication after adding fuel, the ignition
switch should be in the OFF position while the vehicle is being
refueled.
*[IS09860(R)01/96]
The fuel gauge indicator may vary slightly when the vehicle is
in motion.
*[IS09875(R)01/96]
With ignition switch OFF, the fuel gauge indicator may drift
from the ignition switch ON position.
%
The fuel gauge displays approximately how much fuel is in the
fuel tank only when the ignition switch is ON.
[IS10200(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0020063-D
Fuel gauge — mechanical cluster
[IS10300(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0020752-E
Fuel gauge — mechanical cluster with tachometer
*[IS11100(R)03/96]
*[IS11201(R)01/96]
%
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
This gauge tells you the temperature of the engine coolant, not
the coolant level. If the coolant is not at its proper level or
mixture, the gauge indicator will not be accurate.
22
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
*[IS11301(R)01/96]
The pointer moves from the C (cold) mark into the Normal
band as the engine coolant warms up. It is acceptable for the
pointer to fluctuate within the Normal band under normal
driving conditions. Under certain driving conditions, such as
heavy stop and go traffic or driving up hills in hot weather, the
pointer may move to the top of the Normal band.
*[IS11401(R)04/96]
If, under any circumstances, the pointer moves above the
normal band, the engine is overheating and continued operation
may cause engine damage.
*[IS11501(R)03/96]
*[IS11601(R)03/96]
*[IS11701(R)03/96]
If your engine overheats:
1. Pull off the road as soon as it is safely possible.
2. Turn off the engine. If you do not stop the engine as soon as
safely possible, severe engine damage could result.
*[IS11801(R)03/96]
3. Let the engine cool. DO NOT REMOVE COOLANT
*[IS11901(R)01/96]
4. Check the coolant level following the instructions on
*[IS12240(R)01/96]
SYSTEM FILL CAP UNTIL THE ENGINE IS COOL.
checking and adding coolant to your engine. Refer to Engine
coolant in the Index. If you do not follow these instructions,
you or others could be injured.
If the coolant continues to overheat, have the coolant system
serviced as soon as possible.
[IS12300(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020067-F
Engine coolant temperature gauge — mechanical cluster
23
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS12325(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021154-C
Engine coolant temperature gauge — mechanical cluster with tachometer
*[IS12601(R)03/96]
*[IS12700(R)03/96]
Speedometer
*[IS12753(R)03/96]
Some vehicles are equipped with a vehicle speed (mph/km/h)
limiting device that is contained within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). The purpose of this device is to maintain peak
vehicle speed below a specified limit. (Vehicle speed limits may
vary based on engine displacement.)
*[IS12756(R)03/96]
If you are experiencing an “engine cut-out” condition at high
speeds, it may be the result of this limiting device. It is a
normal condition and can be avoided by reducing
vehicle/engine speed.
%
The speedometer tells you how many miles (kilometers) per
hour your vehicle is moving.
[IS12790(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
art:0020873-G
Speedometer
24
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
Instrumentation
*[IS12801(R)03/96]
*[IS12900(R)01/96]
Odometer
*[IS13000(R)01/96]
*[IS13100(R)04/96]
Trip Odometer
% [IS13200(R)04/96]
Tachometer (If equipped)
*[IS13300(R)03/96]
The tachometer will show you the engine’s speed measured in
revolutions per minute (RPM).
*[IS13400(R)03/96]
The tachometer may move slightly when the key is placed in
the ACC or ON position, with the engine off. This is normal
and does not affect the performance of the tachometer when the
engine is running.
*[IS13525(R)03/96]
Some vehicles are equipped with an engine speed (RPM)
limiting device contained within the powertrain control module
(PCM). The purpose of this device is to maintain peak engine
speed (RPM) below a specified limit. This feature is only
evident on automatic transmission vehicles when shifting
manually (1, 2, D) and on all manual transmission units. (Engine
speed limits may vary based on engine displacement.)
*[IS13550(R)03/96]
If you are experiencing an “engine cut-out” condition at high
speeds, it may be the result of this limiting device. It is a
normal condition and can be avoided by reducing
vehicle/engine speed.
%
%
The odometer tells you the total number of miles (kilometers)
your vehicle has been driven.
If you want to track your mileage up to 999.9 miles
(kilometers), use the trip odometer. Simply set the trip odometer
to zero by pressing the reset control firmly when beginning the
distance you wish to measure.
25
File:03unisr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:21:14 1997
[IS13650(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
art:0020258-G
Tachometer
[IS13675(R)01/96]
NOTE: If the 4.0L engine exceeds 5200 RPM, the PCM will
restrict fuel flow to maintain engine speed at or below
5200 RPM. This function is designed to protect the
engine and should be considered normal operation.
26
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29215(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0060682-A
Electronic Sound Systems
Premium Stereo Cassette with CD DJ Compatibility (If Equipped)
27
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29217(R)05/96]
Stereo Cassette with CD DJ Compatibility
*[AS29220(R)03/96]
*[AS29225(R)03/96]
*[AS29230(R)01/95]
Using the Controls on Your New Radio
*[AS29235(R)03/96]
How to adjust the volume
[AS29240(R)06/95]
Turn the “VOL/PUSH” knob clockwise to increase the volume
and counterclockwise to decrease the volume. Bars illuminate in
the display to show relative volume level.
*[AS29245(R)02/96]
NOTE: If the volume level is set above a certain listening
level when the ignition switch is turned off, when the
ignition switch is turned back on, the volume will
come back to a “nominal” listening level. However, if
the radio power is turned off, the volume will remain
in the position it was set at when radio power was
switched off.
*[AS29250(R)03/96]
*[AS29255(R)02/95]
Selecting the AM or FM frequency band
How to turn the radio on and off
Press the “VOL/PUSH” knob to turn the radio on. Press again
to turn it off.
Push the “AM/FM” button to select the desired frequency band
or to stop/store cassette tape (when in cassette mode). Pushing
the button more than once will alternate between AM, FM1 and
FM2. These functions are used with the station memory buttons
described under How to tune radio stations.
28
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
%
*[AS29260(R)03/96]
How to tune radio stations
[AS29265(R)10/94]
There are four ways for you to tune in a particular station. You
can use the “TUNE”, “SEEK”, “SCAN” or the memory buttons.
*[AS29270(R)03/96]
■ Using the “TUNE” function
[AS29275(R)03/95]
You can change the frequency up or down one increment at
a time by pressing and releasing either the left (b) or right
(a) side of the “TUNE” button. To change frequencies
quickly, press and hold down either the right or left side of
the button.
*[AS29280(R)03/96]
Manual tuning adjusts your radio to any allowable broadcast
frequency, whether or not a station is present on that
frequency. (See All About Radio Frequencies in this section.)
*[AS29285(R)04/96]
[AS29290(R)09/94]
*[AS29295(R)04/96]
*[AS29305(R)03/96]
*[AS29310(R)03/96]
■ Using the “SEEK” function
This feature on your radio allows you to automatically select
listenable stations up or down the frequency band. Press the
right (a) side of the “SEEK” button to select the next
listenable station up the frequency band. Press the left (b)
side of the button to select the next listenable station down
the frequency band. By pressing and holding the button,
listenable stations can be passed over to reach the desired
station.
■ Using the “SCAN” function
Pressing the “SCAN” button will begin the scan mode up
the frequency band, stopping on each listenable station for
approximately five seconds.
To stop the scan mode on the presently sampled station,
press the “SCAN” button again.
29
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS29315(R)03/96]
*[AS29320(R)03/96]
■ Setting the station MEMORY PRESET buttons
*[AS29325(R)08/95]
Follow the easy steps below to set these buttons to the desired
frequencies:
Your radio is equipped with 6 station memory buttons.
These buttons can be used to select up to 6 preset AM
stations and 12 FM stations (6 in FM1 and 6 in FM2)
*[AS29330(R)03/96]
*[AS29340(R)10/95]
1. Select a band, then select a frequency.
*[AS29345(R)10/95]
3. Follow the two steps above for each station memory preset
*[AS29350(R)01/95]
*[AS29355(R)01/95]
2. Press one of the memory preset buttons and hold the button
until the sound returns. That station is now held in memory
on that button.
button you want to set.
■ Using the AUTOSET feature
With AUTOSET, you can continually set strong stations into
your memory buttons without losing your originally set
stations.
*[AS29360(R)01/95]
*[AS29365(R)10/95]
Press the “AUTOSET” button once. Your radio will set the
first six strong stations of the band you are in (AM, FM1, or
FM2) into the memory buttons. The display will show
“AUTO”, then run through the frequencies setting the
memory buttons.
NOTE: If there are fewer than five strong stations in the
frequency band, the remaining unfilled buttons will
store the last strong station detected on the band.
*[AS29370(R)01/95]
When all stations are filled, the radio will begin playing the
station stored in memory button 1.
*[AS29375(R)01/95]
To deactivate the Auto Memory Store mode and return to
manually-set memory button stations, press the “AUTOSET”
button. Display will show “AUTO” then “OFF”.
30
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS29380(R)03/96]
*[AS29385(R)02/96]
*[AS29390(R)03/96]
Adjusting the tone balance of your radio
*[AS29395(R)02/96]
*[AS29405(R)03/96]
■ Increasing or decreasing treble response
*[AS29410(R)02/96]
*[AS29415(R)03/96]
■ Adjusting speaker balance
*[AS29420(R)04/96]
*[AS29425(R)03/96]
■ Adjusting speaker fader
*[AS29430(R)10/95]
NOTE: Illuminated bars in the display show relative levels of
bass and treble, and positions of speaker balance and
fader functions (left to right, front to rear).
■ Increasing or decreasing bass response
Press the top c of the “BASS” button to increase bass; press
the bottom d of the “BASS” button to decrease bass.
Press the top c of the “TREBLE” button to increase treble;
press the bottom d of the treble button to decrease treble.
Balance control allows you to adjust the sound distribution
between the right and left speakers. Press the top c of the
“BAL” button to shift the sound to the right speakers, and
press the bottom d of the “BAL” button to shift the sound
to the left speakers.
Fade control allows you to adjust the sound distribution
between the front and rear speakers. Press the top c of the
“FADE” button to shift the sound to the front speakers, and
press the bottom d of the “FADE” button to shift the sound
to the back speakers.
31
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS29435(R)04/96]
Using the Controls of Your Cassette Tape Player
(If equipped)
*[AS29440(R)09/95]
NOTE: Radio power must be on to use the cassette tape
player.
*[AS29445(R)08/95]
*[AS29450(R)04/95]
How to insert a tape
*[AS29455(R)06/95]
NOTE: A cassette tape can be loaded with the ignition on
whether or not the radio power is on. However, with
radio power off, the cassette tape is loaded and stored.
*[AS29465(R)12/95]
*[AS29470(R)08/95]
How to locate a desired track on the tape
*[AS29475(R)09/95]
*[AS29480(R)01/95]
■ Fast forwarding the tape
Your cassette tape player is equipped with power loading. Once
you insert a tape and push slightly (with the open edge to the
right), the loading mechanism draws the tape the rest of the
way in and play will begin after a momentary tape tightening
process. Display indicates “TAPE” while tape is playing.
There are four ways to quickly locate a desired selection on the
tape. You can use the fast forward, rewind, “SEEK” or “SCAN”
function. Following are brief descriptions of each.
To fast forward the tape, press the “FF” button. The radio
will begin playing until fast forward is manually stopped (by
pushing the “TAPE” button) or the end of the tape is
reached.
*[AS29485(R)01/95]
*[AS29490(R)08/95]
*[AS29495(R)01/95]
At the end of the tape, the direction automatically reverses
and plays the other side of the tape.
■ Rewinding the tape
To rewind the tape, press the “REW” button. The radio will
begin playing until rewind is manually stopped (by pushing
the “TAPE” button) or the beginning of the tape is reached.
32
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS29505(R)08/95]
*[AS29510(R)03/96]
■ Using the “SEEK” function with your cassette tape player
*[AS29515(R)08/95]
*[AS29520(R)01/95]
■ Using the “SCAN” function with your cassette tape player
*[AS29525(R)01/95]
While in the tape mode, push the right a side of the
“SEEK” button to seek forward to the next selection on the
tape. Push the left b side to seek the previous tape
selection.
Press the “SCAN” button to begin the forward scan mode on
the tape currently playing, stopping on each tape selection
for approximately an eight-second sampling (display
indicates “SC”).
To stop the scan mode on the presently sampled tape
selection, press “SCAN” a second time.
*[AS29530(R)08/95]
*[AS29535(R)01/95]
■ How to change the side of the tape being played
*[AS29540(R)08/95]
*[AS29545(R)01/95]
How to eject the tape
[AS29550(R)06/95]
How to switch from tape to AM/FM mode
*[AS29555(R)01/95]
Press the “AM/FM” button to stop the tape player and resume
radio play.
*[AS29560(R)02/96]
*[AS29565(R)09/95]
Using the DolbyH B noise reduction feature
The alternate side of the tape can be selected by pressing the
“SIDE 1-2” button.
To stop the tape and eject the cassette, press the “EJ” button.
The radio will resume playing if the radio power is on. The
tape cartridge can be ejected with radio power (and/or ignition)
on or off.
NOTE: Noise reduction system manufactured under license
from Dolby Labs Licensing Corporation. “Dolby” and
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
33
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS29570(R)04/95]
Push the k button to activate Dolby B Noise Reduction. Push
again to deactivate.
*[AS29650(R)05/96]
*[AS29655(R)08/95]
Tips on Caring for the Cassette Player and Tapes
*[AS29660(R)05/96]
■ Using a Ford or equivalent cassette cleaning cartridge to
*[AS29665(R)08/95]
■ Only cassettes that are 90 minutes long or less should be
*[AS29670(R)08/95]
■ Protect cassettes from exposure to direct sunlight, high
*[AS29675(R)08/95]
■ If a tape is loose inside the cassette, tighten it before playing
*[AS29680(R)08/95]
■ Loose labels on cassette tapes can become lodged in the
*[AS29685(R)08/95]
■ Do not leave a tape in the cassette tape player. High heat in
*[AS29690(R)05/96]
*[AS29695(R)05/96]
Clock Operation
[AS29705(R)05/96]
Press the “CLK” button to display time. The time will continue
to be displayed until a radio or tape function is chosen. After
approximately 10 seconds, the time will again appear in the
display. To display radio or tape information only, press the
“CLK” button a second time.
%
In order to keep your cassette tape player performing the way it
was meant to, read and follow these simple precautions:
clean the tape player head after 10-12 hours of play will help
maintain the best playback sound and proper tape operation.
used. Tapes longer than 90 minutes are thinner and subject
to breakage or may jam the tape player mechanism.
humidity and extreme heat or cold. If they are exposed to
extreme conditions, allow them to reach a moderate
temperature before playing.
by putting your finger or a pencil into one of the holes and
turning the hub until the tape is tight.
mechanism. Remove any loose label material before inserting
cassette.
the vehicle can cause the cassette to warp.
How to view the clock mode
34
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
[AS29710(R)09/95]
NOTE: With the ignition off, the clock will display for
approximately 5 seconds once the “CLK” button is
depressed and released.
*[AS29715(R)05/96]
*[AS29720(R)05/96]
How to set the clock
[AS29725(R)05/96]
1. Turn the radio on.
2. Press and hold the “CLK” button, press the right (a) side of
the “SEEK” button to increase hours. Press the left (b) side
of the button to decrease hours. Press the right (a) side of
the “TUNE” button to increase minutes. Press the left (b)
side of the button to decrease minutes.
*[AS29730(R)05/96]
NOTE: The clock displays 12-hour time with no AM/PM
indications.
[AS29735(R)09/94]
Ford 6-CD Changer (If equipped)
[AS29745(R)03/95]
The Ford Ranger (Regular Cab) 6-CD Changer is mounted
behind the driver’s seat. The Ford Ranger (SuperCab) 6-CD
Changer is mounted on the floor near the center of the rear cab
wall. Both changers are controlled with buttons on the Audio
System.
[AS29750(R)10/94]
Unit Loading Instructions
[AS29755(R)06/95]
1. Open Compact Disc Changer unit by sliding door rearward
(Figure 1).
35
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29760(R)09/94]
10-1/2 pica
Figure 1
art:0060686-A
[AS29765(R)03/95]
2. Push the “i” button to eject the disc “magazine” (holds 6
discs) (Figure 2).
[AS29770(R)10/94]
10-1/2 pica
Figure 2
art:0060687-A
36
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS29775(R)04/94]
3. Load discs into the disc magazine slots (numbered 1 through
6) one at a time with labeled surfaces upward, starting with
bottom slot number 1 (Figure 3).
[AS29780(R)09/94]
10-1/2 pica
Figure 3
art:0060688-A
[AS29785(R)08/91]
4. Insert loaded disc magazine into chamber unit with the
arrow on top of the disc magazine pointing toward the
changer (Figure 4). Make sure magazine is fully inserted
into changer.
[AS29790(R)09/94]
7-1/2 pica art:0060689-A
Figure 4
*[AS29795(R)09/95]
*[AS29805(R)01/95]
NOTE: To remove one or more compact disc(s) from the disc
magazine, push the corresponding lever(s) to the back.
Disc(s) will partially come out for easy removal.
5. Close unit by sliding changer panel door to the left.
37
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29810(R)10/94]
The Compact Disc Changer unit is now ready to play using the
controls of your Audio System.
[AS29815(R)05/96]
How to Operate the Ford 6-CD Changer Using the
Controls on the Radio
[AS29820(R)09/94]
If your vehicle is equipped with the Ford 6-CD Changer System,
you can operate it through the controls of your Premium Audio
System.
*[AS29822(R)02/95]
How to begin CD Changer play
[AS29825(R)03/95]
Press the “CD” button to begin CD play. The 6-CD Changer
will automatically begin playing the first track (selection) of the
first disc loaded in the unit. The display will indicate “cd-dd”
for disc number and track number and then display “TT-tt” for
track number and the “dd-tt” for current disc and track number.
[AS29830(R)05/96]
If the CD Changer is empty, “NO CD” will flash in the display
and radio play will continue.
*[AS29835(R)02/95]
How to change the disc being played
[AS29840(R)10/94]
When in the CD mode, you can change discs by pressing the
right side (a) of the “TUNE DISC” button (to select the next
discs) or the left side (b) of the “TUNE DISCS” button (to
select previous discs). Play will begin on the first track of the
selected disc.
[AS29845(R)10/94]
If either side of the button is pressed and held, the CD Changer
will continue fast-forwarding or reversing through the discs in
the disc magazine. During these functions, the display will
indicate the disc number.
38
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS29850(R)10/95]
How to change the track being played
[AS29855(R)04/94]
There are two ways to change the track being played. You can
use the “SEEK” or “SCAN” buttons.
[AS29860(R)04/94]
■ Using the “SEEK” function with your CD-Changer
(a) side of the “SEEK” button to seek
next track of the current disc. After the last
completed, the CD player automatically
next disc.
[AS29865(R)10/94]
Press the right
forward to the
track has been
changes to the
[AS29870(R)04/94]
Press the left (b) side of the “SEEK” button to seek to the
previous track on the current disc.
[AS29875(R)04/94]
■ Using the SCAN function with your CD Changer
[AS29880(R)10/94]
Press the “SCAN” button to move forward to the next track.
Approximately an eight-second sampling of the track will be
played before moving to the next track. The display will
indicate the disc and track number (dd-tt). At the end of the
disc, the CD Changer automatically changes to the next disc.
[AS29885(R)04/94]
To end the scan mode, press the “SCAN” button a second
time.
*[AS29905(R)04/95]
Operating the CD Compression feature
[AS29910(R)04/94]
Because of the wide dynamic range of Ford’s 6-CD Changer
System, soft passages may be difficult to hear under certain
driving conditions while maintaining a reasonable volume level
in the louder passages. The compression feature will bring these
soft and loud passages closer together for a more consistent
listening level.
*[AS29915(R)01/95]
To turn the compression on, press the “COMPRESS”/#5 button.
When the compression feature is activated, the display will
indicate “C”.
39
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS29916(R)02/95]
*[AS29917(R)01/95]
Operating the Shuffle feature
*[AS29918(R)01/95]
The CD Changer will continue to randomly select tracks for
play until the shuffle feature is turned off by pressing the
“SHUFFLE” button a second time.
*[AS29919(R)02/95]
*[AS29920(R)01/95]
How to stop CD play
*[AS29935(R)02/95]
*[AS29936(R)01/95]
CD Error Messages
*[AS29937(R)01/95]
*[AS29938(R)01/95]
*[AS29939(R)01/95]
*[AS29940(R)05/96]
— CD E1 — Mechanism error.
*[AS29941(R)01/95]
*[AS29942(R)05/96]
While in the CD mode, pressing the “SHUFFLE”/#6 button will
randomly select a track from the disc currently being played.
The display will indicate “SHF” followed by the disc and track
number (dd-tt).
While in the CD mode, press the “AM/FM” button to stop CD
play and resume radio play. Also, loading a cassette into the
cassette deck will stop CD play and begin cassette play.
Your system is equipped to diagnose certain problems you may
experience. The error codes are:
— CD E2 — Focus error.
— BAD CD — Disc unreadable.
— TOO HOT — Mechanism over 167˚ Farenheit (75˚C), allow
to cool before playing.
— NO CD — Empty slot or magazine.
— NO DJ — CD Changer not connected, not communicating, or
not equipped.
40
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS29943(R)01/95]
*[AS29944(R)04/96]
Common Operating Conditions of the CD Player
*[AS29945(R)04/96]
*[AS29946(R)04/96]
*[AS29947(R)04/96]
*[AS29948(R)08/95]
■ A disc is already loaded.
*[AS29949(R)08/95]
■ Different manufacturers of compact discs may produce discs
*[AS29950(R)04/96]
*[AS29951(R)04/96]
If play does not begin after the CD button is pushed:
[AS29952(R)10/94]
■ The discs are inserted improperly in the magazine or the CD
The following information is designed to help you recognize
typical situations that could be mistakenly interpreted as
mechanical malfunctions of the disc player.
■ The disc is inserted with the label surface downward.
■ The disc is dusty or defective.
■ The player’s internal temperature is above 140˚F (60˚C).
Allow the player to cool off before operating.
with different dimensions or tolerances, some of which may
not be within industry standards or in accordance with the
CD format. Because of this, a new disc that is free of dust
and scratches could be defective and may not play on your
Ford Compact Disc Player.
■ The radio is not on.
magazine is not inserted.
*[AS29953(R)04/96]
■ Moisture may have condensed on the lenses within the unit.
*[AS29954(R)04/96]
*[AS29955(R)04/96]
If the sound skips:
If this occurs, remove the disc and wait approximately an
hour until the moisture evaporates.
■ Badly scratched discs or extremely rough roads will cause
the sound to skip. Skipping will not damage the disc player
or scratch the discs.
41
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS29956(R)03/96]
How to take care of and clean the CD Changer and
discs
*[AS29957(R)03/96]
To ensure the continued performance of your CD Changer,
carefully read the following precautions:
*[AS29958(R)01/95]
■ Always handle a disc by the edge. Never touch the playing
[AS29959(R)06/95]
■ Before playing, inspect all discs for any contamination. If
surface.
needed, clean discs with an approved disc cleaner, such as
the Discwasher Compact Disc Cleaner or the Allsop 3
Compact Disc Cleaner, by wiping from the center out to the
edges. Do not use a circular motion to clean.
*[AS29960(R)04/96]
■ Do not clean discs with solvents such as benzine, thinner,
*[AS29961(R)01/95]
■ Do not expose the discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for
*[AS29962(R)01/95]
■ Do not insert more than one disc into each disc slot of the
*[AS29963(R)01/95]
■ Do not insert anything other than discs into the disc
commercially available cleaners or antistatic spray intended
for analog records.
an extended period of time.
disc magazine. Doing so may damage the discs, disc
magazine or the disc changer.
magazine.
*[AS29964(R)05/95]
R WARNING
The laser beam used in the compact disc player is
harmful to the eyes. Do not attempt to disassemble the
case.
42
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29965(R)09/94]
33-1/2 pica
art:0060684-A
Electronic Search Radio
Electronic Sound Systems
43
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29966(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090218-B
Electronic Search CD Player
44
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29967(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0060685-B
Electronic Sound Systems
Electronic Search Cassette Radio
45
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS29969(R)05/96]
Electronic Search, Search Cassette Radio,
and Search Single Disc CD Radio
*[AS29970(R)03/96]
*[AS29972(R)03/96]
*[AS29973(R)03/96]
Using the Controls on Your New Radio
*[AS29975(R)03/96]
How to adjust the volume
[AS29980(R)06/95]
Turn the “VOL/PUSH ON” knob clockwise to increase the
volume and counterclockwise to decrease the volume. Bars
illuminate in the display to show relative volume level.
*[AS29985(R)02/96]
NOTE: If the volume level is set above a certain listening
level when the ignition switch is turned off, when the
ignition switch is turned back on, the volume will
come back to a “nominal” listening level. However, if
the radio power is turned off, the volume will remain
in the position it was set at when radio power was
switched off.
*[AS29990(R)03/96]
Selecting the AM or FM frequency band
[AS29995(R)10/94]
Push the “AM”/FM“ button to select the desired frequency
band or to stop/store cassette tape (when in cassette mode).
These functions are used with the station memory buttons
described under How to tune radio stations.
%
*[AS30000(R)03/96]
[AS30005(R)04/95]
How to turn the radio on and off
Press the “VOL/PUSH ON” knob to turn the radio on. Press
again to turn it off.
How to tune radio stations
There are four ways for you to tune in a particular station. You
can manually locate the station using the ”TUNE“ button,
”SEEK“ button, ”SCAN“ button, or select the station by using
the memory buttons, which you can set to any desired
frequency. These four methods are described below.
46
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS30010(R)03/96]
*[AS30015(R)03/96]
*[AS30020(R)03/96]
*[AS30025(R)04/96]
[AS30030(R)05/96]
*[AS30035(R)04/96]
*[AS30040(R)03/96]
*[AS30045(R)03/96]
*[AS30050(R)02/96]
*[AS30055(R)10/95]
■ Using the ”TUNE“ function
You can change the frequency up or down one increment at
a time by pressing and releasing either the left b or right
a side of the ”TUNE“ button.
Manual tuning adjusts your radio to any allowable broadcast
frequency, whether or not a station is present on that
frequency. (See All About Radio Frequencies in this section.)
■ Using the ”SEEK“ function
This feature on your radio allows you to automatically select
listenable stations up or down the frequency band. Press the
right (a) side of the ”SEEK“ button to select the next
listenable station up the frequency band. Press the left (b)
side of the button to select the next listenable station down
the frequency band. By holding the button down, listenable
stations can be passed over to reach the desired station.
■ Using the ”SCAN“ function
Pressing the ”SCAN“ button will begin the scan mode up
the frequency band, stopping on each listenable station for
approximately five seconds.
To stop the scan mode on the presently sampled station,
press the ”SCAN“ button again.
■ Setting the Station Memory Preset buttons
Your radio is equipped with 6 station memory buttons.
These buttons can be used to select up to 6 preset AM
stations and 12 FM stations (6 in FM1 and 6 in FM2).
47
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS30060(R)08/95]
Follow the easy steps below to set these buttons to the desired
frequencies:
*[AS30065(R)03/96]
*[AS30075(R)10/95]
1. Select a band, then select a frequency.
*[AS30080(R)10/95]
3. Follow the two steps above for each station memory preset
*[AS30085(R)10/95]
Adjusting the tone balance and speaker output of your
radio
*[AS30090(R)02/96]
*[AS30095(R)03/96]
■ Increasing or decreasing bass response
*[AS30100(R)02/96]
*[AS30105(R)03/96]
■ Increasing or decreasing treble response
*[AS30110(R)02/96]
*[AS30115(R)03/96]
■ Adjusting speaker balance
*[AS30120(R)04/96]
*[AS30125(R)03/96]
■ Adjusting speaker fader
2. Press one of the memory preset buttons and hold the button
until the sound returns. That station is now held in memory
on that button.
button you want to set.
Press the top c of the ”BASS“ button to increase bass; press
the bottom d of the ”BASS“ button to decrease bass.
Press the top c of the ”TREBLE“ button to increase treble;
press the bottom d of the treble button to decrease treble.
Balance control allows you to adjust the sound distribution
between the right and left speakers. Press the top c of the
”BAL“ button to shift the sound to the right speakers, and
press the bottom d of the ”BAL“ button to shift the sound
to the left speakers.
Fade control allows you to adjust the sound distribution
between the front and rear speakers. Press the top c of the
”FADE“ button to shift the sound to the front speakers, and
press the bottom d of the ”FADE“ button to shift the sound
to the back speakers.
48
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS30130(R)10/95]
NOTE: Illuminated bars in the display show relative levels of
bass and treble, and positions of speaker balance and
fader functions (left to right, front to rear).
*[AS30135(R)04/96]
Using the Controls of Your Cassette Tape Player
(If equipped)
*[AS30140(R)09/95]
NOTE: Radio power must be on to use the cassette tape
player or eject a tape.
*[AS30145(R)08/95]
*[AS30150(R)09/94]
How to insert a tape
*[AS30155(R)09/95]
NOTE: A cassette tape can be loaded and stored with the
ignition and radio power off.
*[AS30165(R)12/95]
*[AS30170(R)09/94]
How to locate a desired track on the tape
*[AS30175(R)09/95]
*[AS30180(R)01/95]
■ Fast forwarding the tape
*[AS30185(R)01/95]
*[AS30190(R)08/95]
*[AS30195(R)01/95]
Your cassette tape player is equipped with power loading. Once
you insert a tape and push slightly (with the open edge to the
right), the loading mechanism draws the tape the rest of the
way in and play will begin after a momentary tape tightening
process.
There are four ways to quickly locate a desired selection on the
tape. You can use the fast forward, rewind, ”SEEK“, or ”SCAN“
function. Following are brief descriptions of each.
To fast forward the tape, press the ”FF“ button. The radio
will begin playing until fast forward is manually stopped (by
pushing the ”TAPE“ button) or the end of the tape is
reached.
At the end of the tape, the direction automatically reverses
and plays the other side of the tape.
■ Rewinding the tape
To rewind the tape, press the ”REW“ button. The radio will
begin playing until rewind is manually stopped (by pushing
the ”TAPE“ button) or the beginning of the tape is reached.
49
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS30200(R)08/95]
*[AS30205(R)03/96]
■ Using the ”SEEK“ function with your cassette tape player
*[AS30210(R)08/95]
*[AS30215(R)01/95]
■ Using the ”SCAN“ function with your cassette tape player
While in the tape mode, push the right a side of the
”SEEK“ button to seek forward to the next selection on the
tape. Push the left b side to seek the previous tape
selection.
Press the ”SCAN“ button to begin the forward scan mode on
the tape currently playing, stopping on each tape selection
for approximately an eight-second sampling (display
indicates ”SC“).
*[AS30220(R)01/95]
To stop the scan mode on the presently sampled tape
selection, press ”SCAN“ a second time.
*[AS30225(R)08/95]
*[AS30230(R)01/95]
■ How to change the side of the tape being played
*[AS30235(R)08/95]
*[AS30240(R)01/95]
How to eject the tape
[AS30245(R)06/95]
How to switch from tape to AM/FM mode
*[AS30247(R)01/95]
Press the ”AM/FM“ button to stop the tape player and resume
radio play.
*[AS30250(R)02/96]
*[AS30255(R)09/95]
Using the DolbyH B noise reduction feature
The alternate side of the tape can be selected by pressing the
”SIDE 1-2“ button.
To stop the tape and eject the cassette, press the ”EJ“ button.
The radio will resume playing if the radio power is on. The
tape cartridge can be ejected with radio power (and/or ignition)
on or off.
NOTE: Noise reduction system manufactured under license
from Dolby Labs Licensing Corporation. ”Dolby“ and
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
50
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS30260(R)04/95]
Push the k button to activate Dolby B Noise Reduction. Push
again to deactivate.
*[AS30345(R)05/96]
*[AS30350(R)08/95]
Tips on Caring for the Cassette Player and Tapes
*[AS30355(R)05/96]
■ Using a Ford or equivalent cassette cleaning cartridge to
*[AS30360(R)08/95]
■ Only cassettes that are 90 minutes long or less should be
*[AS30365(R)08/95]
■ Protect cassettes from exposure to direct sunlight, high
*[AS30370(R)08/95]
■ If a tape is loose inside the cassette, tighten it before playing
*[AS30375(R)08/95]
■ Loose labels on cassette tapes can become lodged in the
*[AS30380(R)08/95]
■ Do not leave a tape in the cassette tape player. High heat in
In order to keep your cassette tape player performing the way it
was meant to, read and follow these simple precautions:
clean the tape player head after 10-12 hours of play will help
maintain the best playback sound and proper tape operation.
used. Tapes longer than 90 minutes are thinner and subject
to breakage or may jam the tape player mechanism.
humidity and extreme heat or cold. If they are exposed to
extreme conditions, allow them to reach a moderate
temperature before playing.
by putting your finger or a pencil into one of the holes and
turning the hub until the tape is tight.
mechanism. Remove any loose label material before inserting
cassette.
the vehicle can cause the cassette to warp.
51
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS30390(R)05/96]
Using the Controls of Your Compact Disc Radio
(If equipped)
[AS30400(R)05/96]
Your Ford Compact Disc Radio is capable of playing 12 cm or 8
cm discs. The player operates when the power is on and a disc
is inserted (label side up). Handle the disc by the edge only. Be
sure to read and follow all of the care and cleaning instructions
under How to Take Care of and Clean Your CD Player and Discs.
[AS30410(R)05/96]
The digital display on your CD player will either show the
track (selection) number or the elapsed time. Select the display
mode by pressing the ”CLK“ button. Indicators for play (a),
stop (X), and compression (C) are also on the display. These
features are described later.
[AS30420(R)05/96]
Once a disc is inserted, operation of the CD player will override
the radio.
[AS30430(R)05/96]
NOTE: The volume, bass, treble, balance, and fader controls
on the radio are also used with the CD player. Refer
to the earlier operating instructions about these
controls.
[AS30440(R)05/96]
Inserting a disc and beginning play
[AS30450(R)05/96]
Insert a disc, label side up, into the disc opening. When
inserted, the disc automatically loads into the unit and play
starts at the beginning of the first track (selection).
[AS30460(R)05/96]
NOTE: Once a disc is inserted, the disc opening is secured to
prevent the accidental insertion of another disc.
[AS30470(R)05/96]
NOTE: The CD player has heat protection circuitry to protect
the laser diode. If the temperature of the player
reaches 167˚F (75˚C), the heat detection circuit will
shut off the player and ”CD HOT“ will scroll in the
display for approximately five seconds (radio will
resume playing). When the temperature returns to
normal operating range, the CD player will again be
operational.
52
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
[AS30480(R)05/96]
How to stop and restart the CD player
[AS30490(R)05/96]
When a disc is loaded, the unit automatically enters the play
mode. To stop temporarily, press the ”AM/FM“ button. The
stop indicator (X) in the display illuminates and operation
returns to the radio mode. To resume CD play, press the ”CD“
button.
[AS30500(R)05/96]
NOTE: If the ignition key is turned to OFF during play and
then is turned to the ON or ACCESSORY position,
the CD player will resume playing in the mode it was
in when the ignition was turned off.
[AS30510(R)05/96]
Using the ”SEEK“ feature
*[AS30520(R)05/96]
The ”SEEK“ feature allows you to quickly find a particular
selection on the disc.
[AS30530(R)05/96]
Press (b) once to repeat the current playing selection. Press
(a) to advance to the next selection. If the (a) button is
pressed during the last selection on the CD, the CD will
advance to the first track on the disc.
[AS30540(R)05/96]
Pressing and holding the (b) or (a) button will scroll
backward and forward respectively through the tracks.
[AS30550(R)05/96]
Using the ”SCAN“ function
[AS30560(R)05/96]
The ”SCAN“ function allows you to briefly sample all tracks on
a disc.
[AS30570(R)05/96]
Press the ”SCN“ button to enter the scan mode. The scan mode
causes the CD to advance to the next track, play for 8 seconds,
and then advance to the next track. This continues until the
”SCN“ button is pressed a second time, the ”CD“ button is
pressed, or a different tuning function is selected.
53
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
[AS30580(R)05/96]
Using the compression feature
[AS30590(R)05/96]
The compression feature will bring soft and loud passages
together for a more consistent listening level.
[AS30600(R)05/96]
Press the ”COMP“ button to turn compression on. When on, the
compression indicator (”C“) will appear in the display. Press the
button again to turn off.
*[AS30610(R)05/96]
How to fast forward or reverse your CD player
[AS30620(R)05/96]
To quickly search for a particular point in a selection, press the
(a) side of the ”TUNE“ button (to fast forward) or press the
(b) side (to reverse). While either button is pressed, the disc
goes forward or backward at two different speeds depending on
how long the button is held down. Pressing and holding either
button for more than three seconds will speed up the process.
Release the button at the desired point (found by watching the
elapsed playing time in the display or by listening to the sound
during fast forward or reverse). When you have reached the
beginning of track 1, the CD player will begin playing.
[AS30630(R)05/96]
When you reach the end of a track, the CD will advance to the
next track and continue at high speed. When the end of the CD
is reached, the fast forward function stops. In a similar way,
holding the (b) button will reverse the CD until the beginning
of the CD is reached.
[AS30640(R)05/96]
How to eject the disc
[AS30650(R)05/96]
Press the ”EJ“ button to stop play, eject the disc, and resume
radio operation.
[AS30660(R)05/96]
NOTE: You can eject the disc while the radio power and/or
ignition is on or off.
54
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS30670(R)05/96]
*[AS30680(R)05/96]
Clock Operation
[AS30690(R)05/96]
Press the ”CLK“ button to display time. The time will continue
to be displayed until a radio or tape function is chosen. After
approximately 10 seconds, the time will again appear in the
display. To display radio or tape information only, press the
”CLK“ button a second time.
[AS30700(R)05/96]
NOTE: The clock can be displayed or set whether the ignition
is on or off.
*[AS30710(R)05/96]
*[AS30720(R)05/96]
How to set the clock
%
[AS30730(R)05/96]
How to view the clock mode
1. Turn the radio on.
2. Press and hold the ”CLK“ button, press the right (a) side of
the ”SEEK“ button to increase hours. Press the left (b) side
of the button to decrease hours. Press the right (a) side of
the ”TUNE“ button to increase minutes. Press the left (b)
side of the button to decrease minutes.
*[AS30740(R)05/96]
NOTE: The clock displays 12-hour time with no AM/PM
indications.
*[AS30750(R)05/96]
*[AS30760(R)05/96]
Common Radio Reception Conditions
%
*[AS30770(R)05/96]
*[AS30780(R)05/96]
Several conditions prevent FM reception from being completely
clear and noise-free, such as the following:
1. Distance/Strength
The strength of the FM signal is directly related to the distance
the signal must travel. The listenable range of an average FM
signal is approximately 25 miles (40 kilometers). Beyond this
distance, the radio is operating in a fringe area and the signal
becomes weaker.
55
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS30790(R)05/96]
*[AS30800(R)05/96]
2. Terrain
The terrain (hilly, mountainous, tall buildings) of the area over
which the signal travels may prevent the FM signal from being
noise-free.
*[AS30810(R)05/96]
If there is a building or large structure between the antenna and
station, some of the signal ”bends“ around the building, but
certain spots receive almost no signal. Moving out of the
”shadow“ of the structure will allow the station to return to
normal.
*[AS30820(R)05/96]
When the radio waves are reflected off objects or structures, the
reflected signal cancels the normal signal, causing the antenna to
pick up noise and distortion. Cancellation effects are most
prominent in metropolitan areas, but also can become quite
severe in hilly terrain and depressed roadways.
*[AS30830(R)05/96]
To minimize these conditions, a stereo/mono blend circuit has
been incorporated into this system. This feature automatically
switches a weak stereo signal to a clearer monaural signal,
which improves the quality of reception.
*[AS30840(R)05/96]
Several sources of static are normal conditions on AM
frequencies. These can be caused by power lines, electric fences,
traffic lights and thunderstorms.
*[AS30850(R)05/96]
Another reception phenomenon is Strong Signal Capture and
Overload. This can occur when listening to a weak station and
when passing another broadcast tower. The close station may
capture the more distant station, although the displayed
frequency does not change. While passing the tower, the station
may switch back and forth a few times before returning to the
original station.
56
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
Electronic Sound Systems
*[AS30860(R)05/96]
When several broadcast towers are present (common in
metropolitan areas), several stations may overload the receiver,
resulting in considerable station changing, mixing and
distortion.
*[AS30870(R)05/96]
Automatic gain control circuitry for both AM and FM bands has
been incorporated into this system to reduce strong signal
capture and overload.
*[AS30880(R)05/96]
*[AS30890(R)05/96]
All About Radio Frequencies
*[AS30900(R)05/96]
Not all frequencies will be assigned to a given area. This radio
will tune to each of these frequencies using manual tune and no
fine tuning is necessary as radio stations may not use other
frequencies.
*[AS30910(R)05/96]
Some FM radio stations advertise a ”rounded-off“ frequency
which is not the frequency they actually broadcast on. For
example, a radio station that is assigned a frequency of 98.7
MHz may call itself ”Radio 99“ even though 99.0 MHz is not an
allowable FM broadcast frequency.
%
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and the
Canadian Radio Telecommunications Commission (CRTC)
establish the frequencies that AM and FM radio stations may
use for their broadcasts. The allowable frequencies are, AM: 530,
540...1600, 1610 kHz in 10 kHz steps; FM: 87.9, 88.1...107.7, 107.9
MHz in 0.2 MHz steps.
57
File:04unasr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:49:21 1997
*[AS30920(R)05/96]
*[AS30930(R)05/96]
*[AS30940(R)05/96]
Important Warranty and Service Information
*[AS30950(R)05/96]
*[AS31000(R)05/96]
Service
%
Warranty
Your sound system is warranted for three years or 36,000 miles
(60,000 kilometers), whichever comes first. Consult your vehicle
warranty booklet for further information. Ask your dealer for a
copy of this limited warranty.
At Ford, we stand behind our audio systems with a
comprehensive service and repair program. If anything should
go wrong with your Ford audio system, return to your dealer
for service. There is a nationwide network of qualified Ford
authorized repair centers to assist you.
58
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF00075(R)05/96]
Your vehicle has a variety of features designed for your
comfort, convenience and safety. Read this chapter to find out
about standard and optional features.
59
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF00225(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090207-D
60
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF00230(R)03/96]
% [CF00235(R)03/96]
*
The Interior and Exterior Lights
[CF00240(R)04/96]
To turn on your headlamps, parking lamps, marker lamps,
license plate lamps and tail lamps, use the headlamp control
knob to the left of the steering column.
%
[CF00250(R)03/96]
Turning On the Exterior Lights
1. Rotate the headlamp control knob to the first position.
Parking lamps, tail lamps, license plate lamps and marker
lamps are now on.
[CF00255(R)03/96]
2. Rotate the headlamp control knob to the next position.
Headlamps are now on in addition to the above.
[CF00260(R)03/96]
3. Rotate the thumb wheel when the headlamp control knob is
in an “ON” position to brighten or dim the instrument panel
lamps. Rotate fully upward to operate courtesy and cargo
lamps.
61
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF00265(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090190-A
Headlamp control knob
[CF00270(R)05/96]
Fog Lamps (If equipped)
[CF00275(R)03/96]
The fog lamps switch is located on the instrument panel to the
right of the radio and climate control.
[CF00280(R)03/96]
■ To turn the fog lamps on, turn on the low-beam headlamps,
then push the fog lamp switch. An indicator light will glow
when the lamps are on.
*[CF00285(R)03/96]
■ To turn off, push the switch again.
62
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF00290(R)03/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0090191-A
Fog lamp switch
*[CF00300(R)03/96]
The fog lamps act as a supplement to the low beam headlamps
under limited visibility conditions such as rain, snow, dust or
fog and operate only when the low beam headlamps are on.
*[CF00305(R)03/96]
To maximize fog lamp bulb life, it is recommended that the fog
lamp switch be turned off after each use prior to turning off the
headlamps.
*[CF00310(R)03/96]
*[CF00315(R)03/96]
*[CF00320(R)03/96]
Daytime Running Light System
*[CF00325(R)03/96]
*[CF00330(R)03/96]
■ The headlamp system is in the OFF position, and
%
(Canadian vehicles only)
The Daytime Running Light (DRL) system turns the high beam
headlamps on, with a reduced light output, when:
■ The vehicle has a fully released parking brake.
[CF00333(R)05/96]
■ The vehicle is running.
*[CF00335(R)03/96]
The high beam indicator light on the instrument cluster will not
be on.
*[CF00340(R)03/96]
R WARNING
The Daytime Running Light (DRL) system will not
illuminate the tail lamps and parking lamps. Turn on
your headlamps at dusk. Failure to do so may result in a
collision.
63
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
%
*[CF00345(R)03/96]
Lighting Up the Instrument Panel and the Interior of
Your Vehicle
[CF00350(R)03/96]
The instrument panel lights can be turned on by turning the
headlamp knob toward either the first or second position. You
can brighten or dim the instrument panel lights by rotating the
thumb wheel.
[CF00355(R)03/96]
The interior lights will shut off after 25 seconds with all the
doors closed, or immediately when the ignition switch is turned
to the ON position, or if the vehicle speed is above five MPH
(8 km/h). The interior lights will turn off after 40 minutes if
any of the doors are left open. Refer to Battery Saver in the
Features section for more details.
*[CF00500(R)03/96]
*[CF00601(R)03/96]
The Climate Control Systems
*[CF00801(R)03/96]
*[CF00901(R)01/96]
Instrument Panel Registers
%
%
Your vehicle is equipped with a control assembly designed to
handle either a combination A/C-Heater System or a
Heater-Only System.
There are four registers in the instrument panel. Each of these
registers contains a louver assembly which can be manually
adjusted to direct airflow up, down, left and right. An
illustration of the register locations follows.
[CF01201(R)05/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020099-E
Instrument panel registers
64
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF01400(R)01/96]
Air Conditioning (A/C) Controls (Manual Air
Conditioning)
*[CF01450(R)03/96]
The control for your air conditioning and heater system is
located at the center of the instrument panel below the radio
and will operate only when the ignition key is turned to the
ON position. Your air conditioner and heater will heat and/or
cool your vehicle interior depending on the function position
and temperature you select. The function selector control knob
allows you to select heating or cooling and determine where the
air will be directed. The temperature control knob setting
determines the temperature of the air that flows into the vehicle.
[CF01500(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Climate control knobs
art:0020589-G
*[CF01550(R)03/96]
To turn your air conditioner and heater system on, select any
position except OFF. This will turn the fan on and allow airflow
into the vehicle. To turn your air conditioner and heater off,
select OFF. This will turn the fan off and stop airflow from
coming into the vehicle.
65
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF01600(R)03/96]
Temperature selection
[CF01650(R)01/96]
The temperature control knob is the rotating knob located at the
center of the control with tapered red and blue bands
surrounding most of the knob. The wide red part of the band
(full right) is the heat or warmer area. The wide blue area (full
left) is the cooling or cool temperature area. Any position
selected between full right and full left will give a temperature
between the two extreme temperatures.
*[CF01700(R)03/96]
H Fan speed adjustment
[CF01750(R)01/96]
The H (left) knob on the control is the fan control knob which
controls the volume of air flow. Rotate the H knob to the right
to increase fan speed and increase the amount of air entering
the vehicle. Four fan speed positions are available and are
indicated by dots beside the H control knob. The largest dot is
high speed position.
*[CF01800(R)03/96]
Airflow selections
[CF01850(R)01/96]
Q (Panel)
[CF01900(R)01/96]
Use Q to bring outside air through the instrument panel
registers. You can heat the air in this position by rotating the
temperature knob into the red area. The air CANNOT be cooled
below the outside temperature regardless of the temperature
knob setting. Select A/C or MAX A/C to get cool air through
the instrument panel registers.
*[CF01950(R)01/96]
A/C
[CF02000(R)01/96]
Select A/C to get refrigerated outside air through the
instrument panel registers. The A/C position is used for cooling
except when it is extremely hot or fast cooling of the vehicle is
needed. Then, select MAX A/C for fast cooling and return to
A/C when you are comfortable.
66
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF02050(R)03/96]
MAX A/C
[CF02100(R)01/96]
The MAX A/C position produces cool air more rapidly to
provide faster cooling of your vehicle. This is possible because
cooler air is drawn from inside the passenger area and
refrigerated again instead of using warmer outside air. Using
inside air will also make the fan sound louder and is normal
when using MAX A/C. The air flow will be from the
instrument panel registers.
[CF02150(R)01/96]
S (Panel and Floor)
[CF02200(R)01/96]
Select S to direct airflow to the floor and through the
instrument panel registers at the same time. This selection can
be used to either heat or cool your vehicle. The air conditioner
will operate to cool the air if the outside temperature is about
50˚F (10˚C) or warmer.
[CF02250(R)04/96]
R (Floor)
[CF02300(R)01/96]
Select R to direct air to the floor. The air cannot be cooled in
the R position but can be heated by rotating the temperature
knob into the red area.
[CF02350(R)01/96]
P (Floor and Defrost)
[CF02400(R)01/96]
Select P to direct air to the floor and windshield defrosters at
the same time. If the outside temperature is about 50˚F (10˚C)
or warmer, the air will also be dehumidified to remove
moisture. This feature will help prevent fogging in humid
weather. The air can be cooled or heated.
% [CF02450(R)04/96]
V (Defrost)
[CF02500(R)01/96]
Select V to obtain maximum airflow to the windshield. Rotate
the temperature knob into the red area for the air temperature
required to defrost. When the outside temperature is about 50˚F
(10˚C) or warmer, the air will be dehumidified to remove
moisture. Rotate the H knob to increase the airflow.
67
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF02550(R)01/96]
*[CF02600(R)03/96]
Operating tips
[CF02650(R)01/96]
■ In humid weather, select V before starting your engine.
The following tips will help you to get the most satisfaction
from your air conditioning (if equipped) and heater system.
This will help to prevent windshield fogging. After a few
minutes of operation, you may select another function.
[CF02700(R)01/96]
■ To prevent humidity buildup inside your vehicle, always
drive with the air conditioner or heater system turned on.
*[CF02750(R)01/96]
■ Do not put objects under the front seats that interfere with
[CF02800(R)01/96]
■ Remove any snow, ice, or leaves from the air intake area of
the flow of air to the back seat area.
your air conditioner and heater system that could block the
air intake. The intake area is located at the bottom of the
windshield.
*[CF02900(R)01/96]
Heater Controls (Heater-Only Vehicles)
[CF02950(R)01/96]
The control for your heater system is located at the center of the
instrument panel below the radio. The heater will operate only
when the ignition key is turned to the ON position. Your heater
will heat and/or ventilate your vehicle interior depending on
the function position and temperature you select. The function
selector control knob allows you to select heating or ventilation
and determine where the air will be directed. The temperature
control knob setting determines the temperature of the air that
flows into the vehicle.
68
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF03000(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Climate control knobs (heater only)
art:0090206-A
[CF03050(R)01/96]
To turn your heater system on, select any position except OFF.
This turns the fan on and allows airflow into the vehicle. To
turn your heater off, select OFF.
*[CF03100(R)03/96]
Temperature selection
[CF03150(R)01/96]
The temperature control knob is the rotating knob located at the
center of the control with tapered red and blue bands
surrounding most of the knob. The wide red part of the band
(full right) is the heat or warmer area. The wide blue area (full
left) is the cool or unheated temperature area. Any position
selected between full right and full left will give a temperature
between the two extreme temperatures. The cool temperature
you select will not be cooler than the outside temperature.
*[CF03200(R)03/96]
H Fan speed adjustment
[CF03250(R)01/96]
The H (left) knob on the control is the fan control knob which
controls the volume of airflow. Rotate the H knob to the right
to increase fan speed and increase the amount of air entering
the vehicle. Four fan speed positons are available and are
indicated by dots beside the H control knob. The largest dot is
high speed position.
69
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF03300(R)03/96]
Airflow selections
[CF03350(R)01/96]
Q (Panel)
[CF03400(R)01/96]
Use Q to bring outside air through the instrument panel
registers. You can heat the air in this position by rotating the
temperature knob into the RED area. The air cannot be cooled
below the outside temperature regardless of the temperature
knob setting.
[CF03450(R)01/96]
S (Panel & Floor)
[CF03500(R)01/96]
Select S to get airflow to the floor and through the instrument
panel registers at the same time. This selection can be used to
either heat or ventilate your vehicle.
[CF03550(R)04/96]
R (Floor)
[CF03600(R)01/96]
Select R to direct air to the floor. The air cannot be cooled in
the R position but can be heated by rotating the temperature
knob into the red area.
[CF03650(R)01/96]
P (Floor & Defrost)
[CF03700(R)01/96]
Select P to get air to the floor and windshield defrosters at the
same time.
% [CF03750(R)04/96]
V (Defrost)
[CF03800(R)01/96]
Select V to obtain maximum air flow to the windshield. Rotate
the temperature knob into the red area for the air temperature
required to defrost. Rotate the H knob to increase the air flow.
70
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF03850(R)01/96]
*[CF03900(R)03/96]
Operating tips
*[CF04000(R)03/96]
■ To prevent humidity buildup inside your vehicle, always
*[CF04050(R)01/96]
■ Do not put objects under the front seats that interfere with
*[CF04100(R)03/96]
■ Remove any snow, ice, or leaves from the air intake area at
[CF18500(R)01/96]
Courtesy and Dome Lamps
[CF19175(R)05/96]
The interior/courtesy lamp is automatically turned on when the
driver or passenger door is opened or doors are unlocked with
the remote entry system (if equipped). Turning the thumb
wheel fully counterclockwise will operate the interior lamp
when the doors are closed.
The following tips will help you to get the most satisfaction
from your heater system.
drive with the heater system turned on.
the flow of air to the back seat area.
the bottom of the windshield.
[CF19185(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021156-B
Interior/Courtesy lamp
71
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
%
*[CF19190(R)03/96]
[CF19200(R)01/96]
Combination Cargo and High-Mount Brakelamp
The combination cargo/high-mount brakelamp is located outside
the vehicle, directly over the rear window. Use the thumb wheel
to turn on the cargo lamp and interior courtesy lights.
[CF19350(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021157-B
Cargo/High-mount brakelamp
*[CF19400(R)03/96]
R WARNING
Do not drive your vehicle with the cargo/courtesy light
on. Showing a white light to the rear while driving on
public roads is illegal in some places.
[CF19700(R)01/96]
Dome/Map Lamps (If equipped)
[CF19825(R)01/96]
The map lamps are located on each side of the dome light
assembly. You can turn the individual map lamps on or off by
sliding the switch to the left or right. To turn off, slide the
switch to the middle.
[CF19950(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020895-B
Map lamps
72
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF20300(R)01/96]
Clock Controls on Electronic Radios
[CF20400(R)02/96]
The electronic radios have a built-in clock. For complete
operating instructions, refer to the Audio Section in this Owner
Guide.
*[CF20405(R)05/96]
The controls on the steering column and wheel are designed to
give you easy access to the controls while you are driving.
*[CF20410(R)01/96]
% [CF20420(R)01/96]
*
Ignition
Understanding the Positions of the Ignition
[CF20430(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021143-A
The positions of the key in the ignition lock cylinder.
%
*[CF20440(R)04/96]
ACCESSORY allows some of your vehicle’s electrical accessories
such as the radio and the windshield wipers to operate while
the engine is not running.
*[CF20442(R)03/96]
In order to turn the key from the ON or OFF position to the
ACCESSORY position, you must push the key release button if
your vehicle’s manual transmission gearshift is mounted on the
floor.
*[CF20444(R)01/96]
LOCK locks the steering wheel and gearshift lever.
73
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF20450(R)01/96]
R WARNING
LOCK position does not lock the gearshift on
floor-mounted manual transaxle gearshifts. If the parking
brake is not set and the gearshift is moved out of gear,
your vehicle may move unexpectedly and injure someone.
*[CF20470(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
*[CF20480(R)01/96]
LOCK is the only position that allows you to remove the key.
The LOCK feature helps to protect your vehicle from theft.
*[CF20482(R)01/96]
If your key is stuck in the LOCK position and will not turn,
move your steering wheel left or right until the key turns freely.
*[CF20484(R)01/96]
OFF allows you to shut off the engine and all accessories
without locking the steering wheel or the automatic
transmission gearshift lever.
*[CF20486(R)01/96]
ON allows you to test your vehicle’s warning lights (except the
brake system warning light) to make sure they work before you
start the engine. The key returns to the ON position once the
engine is started and remains in this position while the engine
runs.
*[CF20490(R)01/96]
START cranks the engine. Release the key once the engine starts
so that you do not damage the starter. The key should return to
ON when you release it. The START position also allows you to
test the brake warning light.
74
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF20500(R)02/96]
*[CF20600(R)02/96]
The Turn Signal Lever
*[CF20700(R)02/96]
*[CF20800(R)03/96]
*[CF20900(R)03/96]
*[CF21000(R)03/96]
% [CF21100(R)01/96]
*
■ operate the turn signals and cornering lamps
%
You can use the turn signal lever on the left side of the steering
column to:
■ turn the high beams on/off
■ flash the lamps
■ turn the windshield wipers and washer on/off
Turn Signals
[CF21600(R)05/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0090131-B
Turn signal lever and functions
*[CF21800(R)08/95]
If the turn indicator light in the instrument panel does not
illuminate or remains on (doesn’t flash) when you signal a turn,
the turn signaling system is malfunctioning. Have this condition
corrected as soon as possible, but make sure that you use the
accepted hand signals in the meantime.
75
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF23200(R)08/95]
High Beams and Flashing the Lamps
[CF23500(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0090130-A
Headlamp high beam switch and turn signal lever on steering column
*[CF24400(R)01/96]
*[CF24500(R)04/96]
%
Windshield Wipers and Washer
To turn on the windshield wipers, the ignition key must be
turned to the ON or ACC position.
[CF24900(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Interval wiper on turn signal lever
art:0020084-D
*[CF25000(R)08/95]
To set the interval wipers, rotate the knob at the end of the turn
signal lever toward or away from the instrument panel to the
interval operation you desire.
76
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF25200(R)01/96]
To clean the windshield, push in the end of the wiper knob for
a single wipe. For a constant spray, keep the knob pushed in.
After you release the knob, the wipers operate for two to three
cycles before turning off (if wipers were off) or returning to the
interval setting selected.
*[CF25300(R)08/95]
Do not try to clean the windshield when the washer fluid
container is empty or activate the washers at any time for more
than 15 seconds continuously. This could damage the washer
pump system.
[CF25350(R)01/96]
NOTE: The addition of shields to the front of the vehicle, as
used to deflect bugs, may also adversely affect the
washer system from delivering fluid to the
windshield. Devices such as bug shields are not
recommended to be added to your vehicle.
*[CF25400(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Always warm up the windshield with the defroster
before you use the washer fluid. In freezing weather, the
washer solution may freeze on the windshield and
obscure your vision.
*[CF25500(R)03/96]
For information about refilling the washer fluid or replacing
your windshield wiper blades, see Windshield washer fluid and
Wipers in the Index.
77
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF25502(R)01/96]
Gearshift Lever (Automatic transmission
only)
[CF25506(R)05/96]
The gearshift lever on your Ranger is mounted on the steering
column. On the end of the gearshift lever is the transmission
control switch. For additional information about the gearshift
lever and the transmission control switch, see the Driving Your
Ranger chapter.
[CF25508(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021255-A
[CF25510(R)05/96]
Transmission Control Indicator Light (TCIL)
[CF25512(R)05/96]
The TCIL indicates the operating range of the transmission. The
TCIL is located in the instrument cluster. This light illuminates
when the transmission control switch is depressed. For
additional information, refer to the Driving chapter.
[CF25514(R)01/96]
6 pica art:0021226-B
78
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF26200(R)05/96]
*[CF26250(R)02/96]
%
Tilt Steering (If equipped)
R WARNING
Never adjust the steering wheel when the vehicle is
moving.
[CF26400(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020088-D
Tilt steering wheel lever
[CF26450(R)04/96]
To change the position of the steering wheel, push the release
lever under the steering column away from you. Tip the
steering wheel to the desired position. Pull the lever back into
place to lock the steering wheel.
*[CF27250(R)01/96]
Be sure the steering wheel locks in a notch. It is not infinitely
adjustable. Do not adjust the steering wheel while the vehicle is
in motion.
*[CF27300(R)03/96]
*[CF27400(R)05/96]
Speed Control (If equipped)
*[CF27450(R)05/96]
Use of radio transmitting equipment that is not Federal
Communications Commission (FCC) or in Canada the Canadian
Radio and Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) approved
may cause the speed control to malfunction. Therefore, use only
properly installed FCC (CRTC in Canada) approved radio
transmitting equipment in your vehicle.
%
The speed of the vehicle cannot be automatically controlled until
the vehicle speed is at or above 30 mph (48 km/h).
79
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF27500(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020091-F
The speed control switches
*[CF27800(R)05/96]
*[CF27820(R)05/96]
*[CF27840(R)05/96]
*[CF27860(R)05/96]
To Turn Speed Control Off
*[CF27880(R)05/96]
*[CF27900(R)05/96]
*[CF27920(R)05/96]
To Turn Speed Control On
[CF27940(R)05/96]
Press SET ACCEL. For speed control to operate, the speed
control must be ON and the vehicle speed must be greater than
30 mph (48 km/h). The SPEED CONT light will illuminate in
the instrument cluster when a speed is set/engaged.
*[CF27960(R)05/96]
If you drive up or down a steep hill, your vehicle speed may
vary slower or faster than the set speed. This is normal.
*[CF27980(R)05/96]
Speed control cannot reduce the vehicle speed if it increases
above the set speed on a downhill. If your vehicle speed is
faster than the set speed while driving downhill in j
(Overdrive), you may want to shift to the next lower gear to
reduce your vehicle’s speed.
%
■ Press OFF,
■ Turn off the vehicle ignition.
Once speed control is switched off, the previously programmed
set speed will be erased.
■ Press ON
To Set a Speed
80
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF28000(R)05/96]
R WARNING
To keep your vehicle under control, do not use speed
control in heavy traffic or on roads that are winding,
slippery, or unpaved.
*[CF28020(R)05/96]
To Set a Higher Speed
[CF28040(R)05/96]
■ Press and hold SET ACCEL. Release the switch when the
desired vehicle speed is reached, or
[CF28060(R)05/96]
■ Press and release SET ACCEL. Each press will increase the
set speed by 1 mph (1.6 km/h)or
*[CF28080(R)05/96]
■ Accelerate with your accelerator pedal, then press SET
*[CF28100(R)05/96]
You may accelerate with the accelerator pedal at any time
during speed control usage. Releasing the accelerator pedal will
return your vehicle speed to the previously programmed set
speed.
*[CF28120(R)05/96]
To Set a Lower Set Speed
[CF28140(R)05/96]
■ Press and hold COAST. Release the switch when the desired
ACCEL.
vehicle speed is reached, or
[CF28160(R)05/96]
■ Press and release COAST. Each press will decrease the set
speed by 1 mph (1.6 km/h) or
*[CF28180(R)05/96]
■ Depress the brake pedal. When the desired vehicle speed is
reached, press SET ACCEL.
81
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF28200(R)05/96]
To Disengage Speed Control
[CF28220(R)05/96]
■ Depress the brake pedal, or
[CF28240(R)05/96]
■ Depress the clutch pedal (if equipped).
[CF28260(R)05/96]
Disengaging the speed control will not erase the previously set
speed and the SPEED CONT light will turn off.
*[CF28280(R)05/96]
To Return to a Set Speed
[CF28300(R)05/96]
■ Press RSM. For RSM to operate, the vehicle speed must be
faster than 30 mph (48 km/h).
*[CF36000(R)02/96]
% [CF38200(R)01/96]
*
%
Doors
Tailgate
[CF38300(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020192-D
Tailgate operation
*[CF38400(R)01/96]
When open, the tailgate load should not exceed 500 lbs
(227 kgs). If you want to load heavy items onto your vehicle,
Ford recommends that you load them one at a time, directly on
the bed floor to avoid damage to the tailgate or its supports.
*[CF38500(R)01/96]
*[CF38600(R)01/96]
To release the tailgate:
Open the tailgate as directed above, but support it to allow for
slack in the cables at both sides. Use a coin or similar object to
pry the spring clip (on each upper cable connector) past the
head of the support screw. Doing so will allow you to center
the wider opening in the connector over the screw head and
disconnect it.
82
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF38700(R)01/96]
If you disconnect the upper end of each cable, you can lower
the tailgate completely.
*[CF38800(R)01/96]
NOTE: Step bumpers or hitches may damage the tailgate if it
is lowered completely.
[CF38900(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020194-C
Releasing the tailgate
*[CF38950(R)01/96]
*[CF39000(R)01/96]
Tailgate removal
First release the tailgate as described above. Be sure to support
the left side to prevent it from falling. Then raise the tailgate to
a 45 degree angle (see the following illustration) and lift the
right side of the tailgate off its hinge. You can now pull the left
side of the tailgate away from the left hinge.
[CF39100(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Tailgate removal
art:0020196-C
83
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF39200(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Do not drive your vehicle with the tailgate open unless
there is a load holding it in place.
%
*[CF39300(R)01/96]
Power Door Locks (If equipped)
[CF39500(R)05/96]
The power door lock switches are located in the front doors. To
lock all doors push the switch marked L. To unlock all doors
push the switch marked U.
*[CF39600(R)01/96]
The manual door locks will override the power door lock
controls.
[CF39700(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020204-F
Power door lock controls
*[CF46500(R)04/96]
% [CF47800(R)01/96]
*
Windows
[CF47900(R)01/96]
Each door has a power control that opens and closes the
window on that door. The driver’s door has a master control
switch that operates all door windows. You must place the
ignition switch in the ON or ACC position to use your power
window controls.
%
Using the Power Windows (If equipped)
*[CF48300(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Do not let children play with the power windows.
84
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF48400(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Master control switch
art:0020211-H
[CF48410(R)05/96]
Sliding rear window (If equipped)
[CF48420(R)05/96]
The sliding rear window has only one sliding portion. Follow
the operating instructions shown in the following illustration.
[CF48430(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
Sliding rear window operation
art:0020210-B
85
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF48450(R)05/96]
SuperCab quarter windows (if equipped)
[CF48460(R)05/96]
To open the optional flip quarter windows on the Ranger
SuperCab models, follow the operating instructions shown in
the following illustration.
[CF48470(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
SuperCab flip open quarter window
art:0020209-B
*[CF48700(R)05/96]
*[CF48800(R)05/96]
*[CF48900(R)05/96]
%
[CF48910(R)01/96]
Dual Electric Remote Control Mirrors (If equipped)
To adjust the remote controlled side mirrors:
1. Find the control switch in the driver’s door panel.
2. Select the right or left mirror by moving the selector switch
to the right or left.
86
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF48920(R)05/96]
3. Move the control knob in the direction you want to move
*[CF48930(R)05/96]
4. Return the selector switch to the middle position to keep the
the mirror.
mirror in place.
[CF49000(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0090159-A
Power mirror control
*[CF49100(R)05/96]
*[CF49200(R)05/96]
Do not clean the plastic housing of any electric mirror with
gasoline or other petroleum-based cleaning products.
R WARNING
The right side view mirror makes objects appear smaller
and farther away than they actually are.
87
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF50000(R)01/96]
Console (If equipped)
*[CF50100(R)01/96]
Your vehicle may have a full console. The full console has the
features shown in the illustration below.
[CF59700(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090211-A
The features on the console — bucket seats
88
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF59800(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020896-C
Storage armrest — 60/40 split bench
[CF66700(R)01/96]
Floor Mounted Cupholders (If equipped)
[CF66900(R)03/96]
If your vehicle has a bench seat, you may have floor mounted
cupholders. On manual transmission vehicles, the cupholders are
located on the floor on either side of the gearshift lever. On
automatic transmission vehicles, a removable consolette is
located on the floor. The consolette may be removed when the
center bench seat position is occupied.
[CF67000(R)01/96]
The inside of the cupholders can be adjusted to various heights
to accommodate different size cups. They can also be removed
to allow access and cleaning of the rubber padding at the
bottom of the cupholder.
89
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF67200(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica art:0020897-E
Floor mounted cupholders — manual transmission
[CF67300(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020962-B
Floor mounted cupholders — automatic transmission
90
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF67400(R)01/96]
[CF67500(R)01/96]
To remove the automatic transmission consolette:
1. Pull the adjustable portion of each cupholder from the
consolette.
[CF67600(R)01/96]
2. Remove the rubber pad at the bottom of each cupholder.
[CF67700(R)01/96]
3. Using a quarter, turn the slotted head at the bottom of each
cupholder 90˚ (one quarter turn).
[CF67800(R)01/96]
4. Lift the consolette from the floor and secure it in a safe
place.
[CF67900(R)05/96]
Power Point Electrical Outlets
[CF67910(R)05/96]
The two power point outlets should be used in place of the
cigarette lighter for optional electrical accessories.
[CF67912(R)06/96]
The instrument panel power point is located to the right of the
radio.
[CF67915(R)05/96]
Vehicles equipped with the Passenger Air Bag Deactivate switch
do not come equipped with an auxiliary power point to the left
of the ashtray.
[CF67920(R)01/96]
NOTE: Do not plug optional electrical accessories into the
cigarette lighter. Use the power point.
91
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF67925(R)05/96]
13-1/2 pica
art:0090227-A
The Instrument panel power point
[CF67930(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020260-E
Power point electrical outlet
92
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF80000(R)05/96]
Remote Entry System (If equipped)
[CF80010(R)01/96]
If your vehicle has the remote entry system, you can lock or
unlock the vehicle doors without using a key. The remote also
has a personal alarm feature. The buttons for the system are
located on the hand held transmitter that came with your
vehicle.
[CF80016(R)01/96]
The system will work with up to four transmitters. Your vehicle
came with one transmitter. Additional transmitters can be
ordered from your dealer.
*[CF80018(R)01/96]
The remote entry features only operate with the ignition in the
OFF position.
93
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
[CF80020(R)05/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0090226-A
The remote entry transmitter
*[CF80080(R)05/96]
*[CF80082(R)04/96]
Unlocking the doors with the remote entry system
[CF80086(R)05/96]
To unlock the other door, press the UNLOCK control a second
time, within five seconds after the first UNLOCK.
*[CF80100(R)05/96]
Locking the doors with the remote entry system
[CF80110(R)05/96]
To lock both doors, press the LOCK control. This will also arm
the factory installed Anti-Theft system.
[CF80114(R)05/96]
If you would like a signal that the doors are being locked, press
the LOCK control again within five seconds. If all doors are
completely closed, the doors will lock again, the horn will chirp,
and the parking lamps will flash. If a door is open or ajar, the
horn will give two short chirps warning you that a door is
open.
%
%
*[CF80200(R)05/96]
[CF80210(R)05/96]
To unlock the driver’s door, press the UNLOCK control.
Remote entry personal alarm
If you wish to activate the remote entry system personal alarm,
press the PANIC control. This will honk the horn and flash the
lights for approximately 2 minutes 45 seconds. You can turn it
off by pressing the PANIC control again from the transmitter or
by turning the ignition to the ON or ACCESSORY position.
94
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
*[CF80212(R)05/96]
When you use the remote entry UNLOCK or PANIC controls,
the illuminated entry system turns on the vehicle’s interior
lights for 25 seconds. You can turn these lights off with the
remote entry LOCK control or by turning the ignition to the
ON or ACCESSORY position.
[CF80214(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021160-A
% [CF80300(R)04/96]
Arming and Disarming the Alarm System with Remote
Entry
[CF80310(R)05/96]
Your Remote Entry System will automatically arm the factory
installed Anti-Theft System when the doors are locked, and
automatically disarm it when the doors are unlocked. The
remote will also reset the anti-theft alarm (when the driver’s
door is unlocked or the PANIC control is pressed on a
programmed remote entry transmitter) if it was triggered.
*[CF80320(R)01/96]
The remote entry system may not arm and disarm non-factory
installed anti-theft systems.
*[CF80500(R)05/96]
*[CF80510(R)05/96]
Replacing the Batteries
%
The remote is powered by two coin type three-volt lithium 2016
batteries (included) that should last for several years of normal
use. If you notice a significant decrease in operating range, the
batteries should be replaced. Replacement batteries can be
purchased at most pharmacies, watch stores or at your Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealer.
95
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF80520(R)01/96]
NOTE: The operating range of the remote entry system can
also be affected by weather conditions (such as very
cold temperatures) or structures around the vehicle
(buildings, other vehicles, radio and TV towers, etc.).
Typical operating range will allow you to be up to 33
feet (10 meters) away from your vehicle.
[CF80530(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021161-A
Opening the remote transmitter
*[CF80540(R)05/96]
The remote can be snapped apart to replace the batteries by
twisting a thin coin between the two halves of the remote. DO
NOT TAKE THE FRONT PART OF THE REMOTE APART.
When installing the new batteries, be sure to place the positive
(+) side down as marked. Snap the two halves back together.
[CF80550(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021162-A
Replacing the batteries
96
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
%
*[CF80560(R)05/96]
Replacing lost transmitters
[CF80562(R)01/96]
In the event a transmitter is lost, you should take your vehicle’s
transmitters to your dealer to have the remote entry system
deprogrammed for the lost transmitter. This is necessary to
prevent further unauthorized use of the lost transmitter.
*[CF80564(R)01/96]
You can also purchase additional transmitters (up to 4
transmitters can be used) from your dealer. You will need to
take all your transmitters to the dealer so they can program
them to the remote entry system all at the same time.
*[CF80570(R)01/96]
*[CF80574(R)01/96]
Illuminated Entry System (If equipped)
[CF80578(R)04/96]
NOTE: The inside lights will not turn off if you have turned
them on with the dimmer thumbwheel or if any door
is open.
%
%
*[CF80600(R)01/96]
This system will provide illumination of the vehicle’s interior
courtesy lamps when either outside front door handle is pulled
or when the remote entry system is used to unlock the door or
sound the personal alarm. The system will automatically turn
off after approximately 25 seconds or when the ignition is
turned to the RUN or ACC position.
Battery Saver
[CF80610(R)04/96]
When the ignition is turned off, the vehicle will turn off battery
voltage to all of these lights after 40 minutes: glove box, engine
compartment, overhead console, mirror, courtesy and
interior (including cargo) lamps.
*[CF80630(R)01/96]
This will prevent draining of the battery if these lights have
been left on inadvertently or if a door is not completely closed.
Battery voltage to these lamps will be restored when the remote
entry transmitter is used, any door is opened, or the ignition
key is turned on again.
97
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
*[CF81000(R)03/96]
*[CF81100(R)01/96]
%
%
*[CF81110(R)01/96]
Anti-Theft Alarm System (If equipped)
When armed, this system helps protect your vehicle against
break-ins or theft.
When an unauthorized entry occurs, the system triggers and
will:
[CF81122(R)01/96]
■ flash the parking lamps and theft indicator lamp
*[CF81124(R)01/96]
*[CF81126(R)01/96]
■ honk the horn
%
*[CF81200(R)01/96]
■ disable the starting circuit to prevent the vehicle from being
started
Arming the System
[CF81210(R)04/96]
The system is ready to arm any time the ignition switch is
turned OFF and the alarm is not triggered or sounding. Any of
the following events will prearm the anti-theft system:
[CF81212(R)05/96]
■ Pressing the remote entry transmitter LOCK control to lock
the doors (with the doors open or closed),
[CF81216(R)05/96]
■ Opening a door and pressing the power door lock control to
lock the doors.
[CF81250(R)01/96]
If a door is open, the anti-theft system is prearmed and waiting
for all doors to close. The THEFT indicator in the instrument
panel will light continuously while the system is prearmed.
[CF81264(R)01/96]
■ Close all doors
[CF81300(R)01/96]
Once all doors are closed, if any were open, the system will
begin a 30 second countdown to become armed. The 30 second
countdown allows people who may still be in the vehicle time
to exit without triggering the alarm. The THEFT indicator will
glow steadily until the system is armed. When the system is
armed, the THEFT indicator will begin to flash with short
flashes every 2 seconds until the system is triggered or
disarmed.
98
File:05uncfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:51:14 1997
Controls and Features
[CF81340(R)01/96]
Remember, all doors must be fully closed for the anti-theft
system to arm. If a door has been left open or ajar, and you
press the remote entry transmitter twice to confirm the doors
are locked, two short horn chirps will warn you that the
anti-theft system is not arming.
[CF81360(R)05/96]
When you get a single horn chirp by pressing the LOCK control
twice within 5 seconds on your remote entry transmitter, you
can be assured that all doors are locked and the anti-theft
system is arming.
% [CF81400(R)01/96]
Disarming the System
[CF81410(R)04/96]
An armed or activated system can be disarmed if you:
[CF81420(R)05/96]
■ Unlock the doors by pressing the remote entry transmitter
UNLOCK control.
[CF81435(R)01/96]
■ Unlock any door with a key.
[CF81439(R)04/96]
■ Turn ignition to the ON or ACC position.
[CF81440(R)04/96]
■ Pressing the remote entry PANIC button will disarm the
anti-theft system only when the anti-theft alarm is triggered
and sounding.
[CF81442(R)04/96]
When unlocking the vehicle with a key, turn the key all the
way to the end of its travel or the system may not disarm.
*[CF81448(R)01/96]
NOTE: The flashing lights and honking horn will shut off
automatically within 2 minutes 45 seconds after the
system is triggered. It will trigger again if another
intrusion occurs. However, the starter circuit remains
disabled until the system is disarmed.
*[CF81450(R)01/96]
The anti-theft system is designed to work with the factory
installed remote entry system. It may not work with other
remote entry systems.
99
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS00125(R)05/96]
% [SS00200(R)01/96]
*
Seats
[SS00210(R)01/96]
Regular Cab
*[SS00220(R)01/96]
*[SS00222(R)01/96]
To move the front seat forward or rearward:
%
Adjusting the Front Seat Manually
1. Find the adjustment lever at the lower left corner of the
front seat.
*[SS00224(R)01/96]
*[SS00226(R)01/96]
2. Push the lever to the left to unlock the seat.
[SS00228(R)01/96]
4. Release the lever to lock the seat in its new position. Make
3. Move the seat to the desired position.
sure the seat locks securely in place.
[SS00240(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Adjusting the bench seat
art:0020859-C
101
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS00250(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Adjusting the bucket seat
art:0020911-C
[SS00260(R)01/96]
SuperCab
*[SS00262(R)01/96]
To move the front seat forward or rearward:
[SS00264(R)01/96]
1. Find the adjustment bar at lower front of the front seat.
[SS00266(R)01/96]
2. Lift bar upward to unlatch the seat.
*[SS00268(R)01/96]
3. Move the seat to the desired position.
[SS00270(R)01/96]
4. Release the bar to latch the seat in its new position. Make
sure the seat latches securely in place.
102
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS00280(R)01/96]
13-1/2 pica
art:0021273-A
*[SS00290(R)05/96]
Adjusting the bucket seat
R WARNING
Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the
vehicle is moving.
*[SS00300(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Cargo should always be secured to prevent it from
shifting and causing damage to the vehicle or harm to
passengers.
*[SS00310(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Always drive and ride with your seatback upright and
the lap belt snug and low across the hips.
*[SS00320(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Children should always ride with the seatback in the
fully upright position.
103
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS00330(R)01/96]
Reclining Bucket Seats (If equipped)
[SS00332(R)01/96]
If your vehicle is equipped with the optional reclining bucket
seat, you can tilt the seatback up to 30 degrees rearward.
*[SS00334(R)01/96]
*[SS00336(R)01/96]
*[SS00338(R)01/96]
1. On the side of the seat, find the handle for the recliner.
*[SS00340(R)01/96]
*[SS00342(R)01/96]
4. Release the handle to lock the seatback in position.
[SS00354(R)01/96]
2. Lift the handle up and hold it in place.
3. Lean against the back of the seat and adjust it to the position
you want.
5. To return the seatback to upright position, lift the handle
and lean forward. Then release the handle.
Lifting the recliner handle of an unoccupied seat will allow the
seat back to fold forward for access to the rear. Pushing the seat
back with the release handle raised returns the seat back to the
upright position.
[SS00356(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Reclining bucket seat
art:0021165-A
104
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS00549(R)01/96]
Center Facing Jump Seat — SuperCab Only
[SS00551(R)01/96]
To open the seat, pull inboard and down on the seat handle. To
stow the seat, pull seat bottom back to the fully upright
position. The jump seats should be kept in the stored position
for easier access to the rear cab area.
[SS00560(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Center facing jump seat in stowed position
art:0020232-B
*[SS00570(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Do not install a child seat in a center facing jump seat.
[SS00580(R)01/96]
Tilt Slide Seat (If equipped)
[SS00590(R)01/96]
SuperCab only
[SS00610(R)01/96]
With the front seatback tilted forward, the tilt slide seat can be
moved to provide additional entry space to access the rear seat
compartment of the vehicle.
*[SS00620(R)01/96]
To operate the tilt slide seat:
[SS00622(R)01/96]
1. Lift the seatback release lever on the outboard side of the
seat cushion to unlock the slide mechanism and seatback.
*[SS00624(R)01/96]
2. Push the seat assembly forward to provide entry space to the
rear seat compartment of the vehicle.
105
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS00630(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Check to see that the seat and seatback are latched
securely in position. Keep floor area free of objects that
would prevent proper seat engagement. Never attempt to
adjust the seat while the vehicle is in motion.
*[SS00640(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Check to see that the seat and seatback are latched
securely in position. Keep floor area free of objects that
would prevent proper seat engagement. Never attempt to
adjust the seat while the vehicle is in motion.
[SS00650(R)01/96]
3. With the seatback still forward, using the seat cushion push
the seat rearward to the desired position and return the
seatback to its upright position. This will lock the seat track.
[SS00652(R)01/96]
NOTE: Whenever the seatback is returned to the upright
position, the seat will lock in that seat position.
*[SS00654(R)01/96]
NOTE: The seat can no longer be moved rearward when in
its latched position.
106
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS00656(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Tilt slide seat
art:0021166-A
*[SS00670(R)01/96]
Prior to operating the vehicle, check to ensure that the seat
assembly is locked by pushing or pulling the seat forward or
rearward. If seat does not lock, repeat steps 2 and 3.
[SS00675(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Locking tilt slide seat
art:0021167-B
107
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS00680(R)01/96]
[SS00681(R)01/96]
To operate the seat adjuster:
4. To adjust the seats forward or rearward, locate the release
bar at the lower front area of the seat cushion. Lift the
release bar and hold until the desired seat position is
obtained, then release the bar to relock the seat.
[SS00690(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Adjusting seat
art:0021168-B
[SS00700(R)01/96]
60/40 Split Front Bench (If equipped)
[SS00704(R)01/96]
The seat back release operates the same as the basic bucket seat.
[SS00720(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020241-D
60/40 split front bench
108
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS00740(R)01/96]
*[SS00742(R)01/96]
%
Using the Power Seats (If equipped)
If your vehicle has the power seat option, you can adjust it in
several directions. The controls are on the outboard side of the
seat.
[SS00750(R)05/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020888-C
The power controls on the driver’s seat
[SS00810(R)05/96]
Inflating the lumbar support
[SS00812(R)05/96]
If your vehicle is equipped with this option you can
inflate/deflate the lumbar support pad in the seat back.
[SS00816(R)01/96]
To inflate the lumbar support pad, push the “+” end of the rear
rocker switch. To deflate the lumbar support pad, push the “s”
end of the switch.
109
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS00830(R)05/96]
16 pica
art:0021169-D
Power lumbar switch — sport bucket seat
*[SS00900(R)02/96]
*[SS00910(R)05/96]
Important Safety Belt Information
*[SS00920(R)02/96]
*[SS00930(R)02/96]
*[SS00950(R)02/96]
*[SS01000(R)02/96]
*[SS01100(R)02/96]
*[SS01200(R)02/96]
*[SS02050(R)02/96]
Safety belts provide best restraint when:
%
The use of safety belts helps to restrain you and your
passengers in case of a collision. In most states and in Canada,
the law requires their use.
■ the seatback is upright
■ the occupant is sitting upright (not slouched)
■ the lap belt is snug and low on the hips
■ the shoulder belt is snug against the chest
■ the knees are straight forward
To help you remember to fasten your safety belt, a warning
light may come on and a chime may sound. See Safety Belt
Warning Light and Chime in the Instrumentation chapter.
110
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS02100(R)02/96]
*[SS02200(R)02/96]
See the following sections in this chapter for directions on how
to properly use these safety belts. Also see Safety Restraints for
Children in this chapter for special instructions about using
safety belts for children.
R WARNING
Always drive and ride with your seatback upright and
the lap belt snug and low across the hips.
*[SS02500(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot
protect the child from injury in a collision.
*[SS02550(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Ford recommends that all safety belt assemblies and
attaching hardware should be inspected by a qualified
technician after any collision. Safety belt assemblies not
in use during a collision should also be inspected and
replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted.
*[SS02600(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Children should always ride with the seatback in the
fully upright position.
111
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS02800(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific safety
belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the
shoulder belt on the outside shoulder only. Never wear
the shoulder belt under the arm. 2) Never swing it
around your neck over the inside shoulder. 3) Never use
a single belt for more than one person.
*[SS02900(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Lock the doors of your vehicle before driving to lessen
the risk of the door coming open in a collision.
*[SS02950(R)05/96]
R WARNING
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside
or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or
killed. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts.
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a
safety belt properly.
*[SS03000(R)02/96]
*[SS03200(R)02/96]
Combination Lap and Shoulder Belts
*[SS03400(R)01/96]
After you get into your vehicle, close the door and lock it. Then
adjust the seat to the position that suits you best.
*[SS03500(R)02/96]
Pull the combination lap/shoulder belt from the retractor so
that the shoulder portion of the belt crosses your shoulder and
%
While your vehicle is in motion, the combination lap and
shoulder belt adjusts to your movement. However, if you brake
hard, turn hard, or if your vehicle receives an impact of 5 mph
(8 km/h) or more, the lap/shoulder belt locks and helps reduce
your forward movement.
112
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
chest. Be sure the belt is not twisted. If it is, remove the twist.
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a
snap and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened
to the buckle by pulling on tongue.
[SS03510(R)02/96]
one third page
Fastening the outboard lap/shoulder belts
art:0001196-A
*[SS03511(R)02/96]
NOTE: Be sure to read and understand Important Safety Belt
Information in this chapter.
[SS03512(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Unfastening the outboard lap/shoulder belts
art:0021301-A
113
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS03513(R)02/96]
While the belt retracts, guide the tongue to its original position
to prevent it from striking you or the vehicle.
*[SS03514(R)01/96]
Safety Belts for Front Outboard Passenger and Rear
Outboard Seating Positions
*[SS03516(R)01/96]
Your vehicle is equipped with a dual locking mode retractor on
the shoulder belt portion of the combination lap/shoulder safety
belt for the front seat outboard passenger and rear outboard
passengers.
*[SS03518(R)02/96]
*[SS03519(R)02/96]
*[SS03520(R)02/96]
Dual locking mode retractors operate in two ways:
*[SS03521(R)02/96]
*[SS03522(R)01/96]
Automatic locking mode
*[SS03523(R)01/96]
*[SS03524(R)01/96]
*[SS03525(R)01/96]
■ A tight lap/shoulder belt on the occupant.
%
Vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode
In this operating mode, the shoulder belt retractor will allow the
occupant freedom of movement, locking tight only on hard
braking, hard cornering or impacts of approximately 5 mph
(8 km/h) or more. The retractor can also be made to lock by
pulling the belt out quickly.
In this operating mode, the shoulder belt retractor will be
automatically locked and will remain locked when the
combination lap/shoulder safety belt is buckled, and does not
allow the occupant freedom of movement. This mode provides
the following:
■ Child safety seat installation.
This mode must be used when installing a child safety seat on
the front passenger seat and rear outboard seats where dual
locking retractors are provided.
114
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS03529(R)01/96]
To switch the retractor from the emergency locking mode to the
automatic locking mode, perform the following steps:
*[SS03530(R)02/96]
*[SS03531(R)01/96]
1. Buckle the lap/shoulder combination belt.
*[SS03532(R)02/96]
3. A clicking sound will continue to be heard as the belt is
2. Grasp the shoulder portion of the belt and pull downward
until all of the belt is extracted and, when allowed to retract,
a clicking sound is heard. At this time, the belt retractor is in
the automatic locking mode (child restraint mode).
allowed to retract. This indicates that the retractor is in the
automatic locking mode.
*[SS03533(R)02/96]
NOTE: When the combination lap/shoulder belt is unbuckled
and allowed to retract completely, the retractor will
switch to the vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking
mode. See the detailed instructions under Safety Seats
for Children in this chapter.
*[SS03534(R)01/96]
*[SS03535(R)05/96]
Shoulder Belt Height Adjustment
[SS03536(R)01/96]
The driver and right front passenger shoulder belt height is
adjustable to one of four (4) positions (Regular cab model) or
five (5) positions (Super cab model).
*[SS03537(R)05/96]
To adjust the belt down, push the release button on the adjuster
down and slide the adjuster down. Then release the button and
make sure the adjuster is firmly in one of the positions. To
adjust the belt up, slide the adjuster up. (You do not have to
push the release button.) Slide it up or down until the belt rests
across the middle of your shoulder.
%
Driver and right front passenger
115
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS03540(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Position the shoulder belt height adjuster so that the belt
rests across the middle of your shoulder. Be sure the
shoulder belt is properly positioned on your shoulder
each time you use the belt. If the shoulder belt is off
your shoulder, on your upper arm or neck, there is a
greater risk of severe injury in a collision.
*[SS03550(R)05/96]
NOTE: Be sure the belt is properly positioned on your
shoulder each time you use the belt.
[SS03552(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090166-B
Shoulder belt height adjuster — full up position (regular cab models)
116
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS03558(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0021279-B
*[SS03600(R)05/96]
Shoulder belt height adjuster — full up position (SuperCab models)
R WARNING
Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific safety
belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the
shoulder belt on the outside shoulder only. Never wear
the shoulder belt under the arm. 2) Never swing it
around your neck over the inside shoulder. 3) Never use
a single belt for more than one person.
*[SS03700(R)01/96]
To tighten the lap portion of the belt, pull up on the shoulder
belt until it fits you snugly. The belt should rest as low on your
hips as possible.
117
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS03800(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Unfastening the outboard lap/shoulder belts
art:0021301-A
[SS05800(R)01/96]
Center Front Lap Belt (If equipped)
[SS05900(R)01/96]
The lap belt in the center of the front seat does not adjust
automatically. You must adjust it to fit snugly around your
hips. Do not wear it around your waist.
*[SS05950(R)01/96]
To fasten the belt, pull the belt across your hips and insert the
tongue into the correct buckle on your seat until you hear a
snap and feel it lock. Make sure the buckle is securely fastened.
%
*[SS06100(R)01/96]
If you need to lengthen the belt, unfasten it and tip the belt
tongue at a right angle to the belt. Pull the belt tongue over
your lap until it reaches the buckle.
*[SS06400(R)01/96]
If you need to shorten the belt, pull on the loose end of the
webbing until the belt fits snugly.
[SS06500(R)01/96]
To unfasten the belt, push the release button on the buckle. This
allows the tongue to unlatch from the buckle.
[SS06600(R)01/96]
Because the center front lap belt does not have a retractor, it
should be shortened and fastened when not in use.
118
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS06700(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Fastening and unfastening the front center safety belt
art:0021123-A
*[SS06800(R)05/96]
R WARNING
The lap belts should fit snugly and as low as possible
around the hips, not around the waist.
[SS07900(R)01/96]
Rear Lap Belt with Retractor
[SS08000(R)01/96]
Pull the belt out of the retractor with a steady motion and insert
the tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap and
feel the latch engage.
[SS08500(R)04/96]
To Unfasten the Safety Belts with Retractors:
*[SS08600(R)08/95]
1. Push the release button on the buckle. This allows the
*[SS08700(R)01/96]
2. While the belt retracts, guide the tongue to its stowed
tongue to unlatch from the buckle.
position. If you do not guide the tongue, it may strike you
or part of the vehicle.
119
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS09600(R)02/96]
*[SS09700(R)01/96]
Safety Belt Extension Assembly
*[SS09790(R)01/96]
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the
safety belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of
the webbing on the label. Also, use the safety belt extension
only if the safety belt is too short for you when fully extended.
Do not use extension to change the fit of the shoulder belt
across the torso.
%
For some people, the safety belt may be too short even when it
is fully extended. You can add about eight inches (20 cm) to the
belt length with a safety belt extension assembly (part number
611C22). Safety belt extensions are available at no cost from
your dealer.
*[SS09800(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Failure to follow these instructions will affect the
performance of the safety belts and increase the risk of
personal injury.
*[SS09900(R)03/96]
*[SS10000(R)02/96]
Safety Belt Maintenance
[SS10030(R)01/96]
The short plastic boot on the front safety belt at the outboard
anchor location (Regular Cab, driver; SuperCab, driver and
passenger) covers an energy absorbing sew pattern on the safety
belt. In the event of an accident, the sew pattern may release,
and the colored label (REPLACE BELT) may become visible. If
this occurs, the safety belt must be replaced.
%
Check the safety belt systems periodically to make sure that
they work properly and are not damaged.
120
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS10035(R)01/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0021286-B
Energy absorbing sew pattern
121
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS10040(R)01/96]
R WARNING
FAILURE TO REPLACE THE SAFETY BELT ASSEMBLY
UNDER THE ABOVE CONDITIONS COULD RESULT
IN SEVERE PERSONAL INJURIES IN THE EVENT OF
A COLLISION.
[SS10200(R)05/96]
%
*[SS10300(R)05/96]
*[SS10800(R)05/96]
All safety belt assemblies, including retractors, buckles, front
seat belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped) child safety seat
tether bracket assemblies (if equipped), and attaching hardware,
should be inspected after any collision. Ford recommends that
all safety belt assemblies used in vehicles involved in a collision
be replaced. Hoever, if the collision was minor and a qualified
technician finds that the belts do not show damage and
continue to operate properly, they do not need to be replaced.
Safety belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also
be inspected and replaced if either damage or improper
operation is noted.
Air Bag Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS)
The driver and right front passenger air bags are Supplemental
Restraint Systems (SRS), provided at these seating positions in
addition to the lap/shoulder belt, and are designed to
supplement the protection provided to properly belted
occupants in moderate to severe frontal collisions. The
supplemental air bag system does not provide restraint to the
lower body.
122
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS10900(R)05/96]
*[SS11050(R)03/96]
%
The Importance of Wearing Safety Belts
R WARNING
All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver, should
always wear their safety belts, even when an air bag
Supplemental Restraint System is provided.
*[SS11100(R)05/96]
There are four very important reasons to use safety belts even
with an air bag system. Use your safety belts to:
*[SS11200(R)05/96]
■ help keep you in the proper position (away from the air bag)
*[SS11300(R)05/96]
■ reduce the risk of harm in rollover, side or rear impact
*[SS11350(R)05/96]
■ reduce the risk of harm in frontal collisions that are not
*[SS11400(R)05/96]
*[SS11500(R)03/96]
■ reduce the risk of being thrown from your vehicle
when it inflates
collisions, because an air bag is not designed to inflate in
such situations
severe enough to activate the supplemental air bag
R WARNING
The supplemental air bags are not designed to protect
occupants in the front center seating position.
*[SS11600(R)05/96]
*[SS11700(R)05/96]
%
The Importance of Being Properly Seated
In a collision, the air bag must inflate extremely fast to help
provide additional protection for you. In order to do this, the
air bag must inflate with considerable force. If you are not
seated in a normal riding position with your back against the
seatback, the air bag may not protect you properly and could
possibly hurt you as it inflates.
123
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS11850(R)01/96]
Important Information About the Right Front Passenger
Air Bag (If equipped)
[SS11900(R)01/96]
It is important for the front seat passengers’ safety that they
remain properly seated whenever the vehicle is moving. This
means that small children should be secured in appropriate
child safety seats or infant seats, and all other occupants should
sit upright, with their backs against the seatback, and restrained
by lap and shoulder belts. No passenger should sit toward the
front edge of the seat, or stand or lean near the air bag cover
(which is near the glove box).
[SS12150(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Rear-facing infant seats should not be placed in the front
seat unless the passenger air bag deactivate switch is
turned to OFF. In rear-facing infant seats, the infant’s
head is closer to the passenger air bag. The force of the
rapidly inflating air bag could push the top of the
rear-facing seat against the vehicle seatback. Turning the
passenger air bag deactivate switch to OFF will prevent
the passenger air bag from deploying, avoiding any
interaction between the passenger air bag and the
rear-facing infant seat.
124
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS12605(R)05/96]
Passenger Air Bag Deactivate Switch (If equipped)
[SS12610(R)01/96]
If your vehicle is equipped with the passenger air bag option, it
also has a passenger air bag deactivate switch. The switch is
located at the lower center of the instrument panel, next to the
ashtray. The switch must be used to turn off the passenger air
bag when a rear-facing infant seat is installed in the right front
or center front passenger seat position. To turn the passenger air
bag off:
[SS12613(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
art:0090221-A
[SS12615(R)01/96]
[SS12620(R)01/96]
[SS12625(R)01/96]
[SS12630(R)01/96]
[SS12635(R)01/96]
NOTE: If the yellow peel-off label is still on the switch, pull
the tab to remove it, and discard it.
1. Insert the ignition key into the switch.
2. Rotate the ignition key clockwise until the key points to the
word OFF printed on the instrument panel.
3. Remove the ignition key.
R WARNING
In order to avoid inadvertent deployment of the
passenger air bag, always remove the ignition key from
the passenger air bag deactivate switch.
[SS12640(R)01/96]
4. Check that the amber OFF light illuminates when the
ignition switch is placed in ON.
125
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS12645(R)01/96]
R WARNING
If the light fails to illuminate when the passenger air bag
switch is in the OFF position and the ignition switch is
in ON, have the passenger air bag switch serviced at
your Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer immediately.
[SS12650(R)01/96]
The passenger air bag will remain off until it is turned on.
When the infant seat is removed, turn the air bag on. To turn
the passenger air bag on:
[SS12655(R)01/96]
1. Insert the ignition key into the switch.
[SS12660(R)01/96]
2. Rotate the ignition key counterclockwise until it points to the
ON printed on the instrument panel.
[SS12665(R)01/96]
3. Remove the ignition key from the switch.
[SS12670(R)01/96]
4. Check that the amber OFF light is not illuminated when the
ignition switch is placed in ON.
[SS12675(R)01/96]
R WARNING
If the light is illuminated when the passenger air bag
switch is in the ON position and the ignition switch is in
ON, have the passenger air bag switch serviced at your
Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer immediately.
[SS12680(R)01/96]
The amber OFF light warns the driver and any passengers that
the passenger air bag is turned off. The passenger air bag
should be turned off ONLY when the rear-facing infant seat is
installed at the right front or center front seats.
[SS12685(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Keep the passenger air bag turned on unless there is a
rear-facing infant seat installed in the front seat. When
the passenger air bag switch is turned off, the passenger
air bag will not inflate in a collision.
126
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
%
*[SS12700(R)05/96]
[SS12750(R)01/96]
How Does the Air Bag Supplemental Restraint System
Work?
The Air Bag Supplemental Restraint System consists of the
driver air bag, passenger air bag (if equipped), impact sensors, a
system diagnostic module, a readiness light and tone, and the
electrical wiring which connects the components.
[SS12775(R)05/96]
24 pica art:0090169-C
The location of the air bags and warning labels
127
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS12900(R)01/96]
The driver air bag is in the center of the steering wheel. The
right front passenger seat air bag (if equipped) is in the upper
right hand section of the instrument panel ledge above the
glove compartment.
*[SS13010(R)05/96]
If a collision occurs, the sensors sense the severity of the impact
and activate the air bags if necessary. The air bag system is
designed to deploy in frontal and front-angled collisions more
severe than hitting a parked vehicle (of similar size and weight)
head-on at about 28 mph (45 km/h). Because the system senses
the crash severity rather than vehicle speed, some frontal
collisions at speeds above 28 mph (45 km/h) will not inflate the
air bag.
*[SS13020(R)05/96]
When the sensors activate the system, the air bags inflate
rapidly, filling with non-toxic nitrogen gas in a fraction of a
second. Immediately after inflation, the air bags deflate by
releasing the nitrogen gas through vent holes. The whole
process takes place in a matter of seconds.
[SS13025(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Do not place objects or mount equipment on or near the
air bag cover on the steering wheel or in front seat areas
that may come in contact with a deploying air bag.
Failure to follow this instruction may increase the risk of
personal injury in the event of a collision.
*[SS13030(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Several air bag system components get hot after inflation.
Do not try to touch them after inflation.
128
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
%
*[SS13050(R)05/96]
The air bag system uses a readiness light on the instrument
cluster and a tone to indicate the condition of the system. When
you turn the ignition key to the ON position, this light will
illuminate for approximately six (6) seconds and then turn off.
This indicates that the system is operating normally. NOTE:
Maintenance of the air bag system is not required.
*[SS13060(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0050087-A
Inflated driver-side air bag
129
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS13070(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0050088-A
Inflated passenger-side air bag
*[SS13080(R)05/96]
R WARNING
The air bag will inflate only once. The system is
designed to function on a one-time-only basis. If the air
bag is inflated, THE AIR BAG WILL NOT FUNCTION
AGAIN AND MUST BE REPLACED IMMEDIATELY. If
the air bag is not replaced, this will increase the risk of
injury in a subsequent collision.
*[SS13090(R)05/96]
To ensure that the air bag system will operate as intended in a
crash, the system is equipped with a diagnostic module, which
controls a readiness lamp and a warning tone. The diagnostic
module monitors its own circuits, the air bag electrical system,
the air bag readiness light, the air bag power and the air bag
inflators.
130
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
%
*[SS13100(R)05/96]
A problem with the system is indicated by one or more of the
following:
*[SS13125(R)05/96]
*[SS13150(R)05/96]
■ the readiness light will either flash or stay illuminated,
*[SS13175(R)05/96]
■ or a group of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will
*[SS13225(R)01/96]
If any of these things happen, have the air bag system serviced
at your Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer immediately. Unless
serviced, the air bag supplemental restraint system may not
function properly in the event of a collision.
*[SS13300(R)05/96]
■ or it will not illuminate immediately after ignition is turned
on,
repeat periodically until the problem and light are repaired.
R WARNING
Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the Air Bag
Supplemental Restraint System or its fuses. See your
Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.
*[SS13680(R)05/96]
*[SS13700(R)05/96]
%
*[SS14300(R)01/96]
*[SS14400(R)01/96]
%
Disposal of air bags and air bag equipped vehicles
For disposal of air bags or air bag equipped vehicles, see your
local Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer. Air bags MUST be
disposed of by qualified personnel.
Safety Restraints for Children
In the U.S. and Canada, you are required by law to use safety
restraints for children. If small children ride in your vehicle —
this generally includes children who are four years old or
younger and who weigh 40 pounds (18 kg) or less — you must
put them in safety seats that are made specially for children.
Safety belts alone do not provide maximum protection for these
children. Check your local and state laws for specific
requirements.
131
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS14500(R)02/96]
R WARNING
Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot
protect the child from injury in a collision.
*[SS14550(R)01/96]
R WARNING
To prevent the risk of injury, make sure children sit
where they can be properly restrained.
*[SS14600(R)05/96]
R WARNING
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside
or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or
killed. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts.
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a
safety belt properly.
*[SS14800(R)05/96]
When possible, put children in the rear seat of your vehicle.
Accident statistics suggest that children are safer when properly
restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating
positions.
*[SS14900(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Do not install a child seat in a center facing jump seat.
*[SS15000(R)01/96]
R WARNING
Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle that
has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you
place a child anywhere near them.
132
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS15025(R)03/96]
R WARNING
Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets
unattended in your vehicle.
*[SS15900(R)01/96]
*[SS16000(R)01/96]
Safety Seats for Children
*[SS16015(R)01/96]
Ford recommends the use of a child safety seat having a top
tether strap. Install the child safety seat in a seating position
which is capable of providing a tether anchorage. For more
information on top tether straps see Attaching Safety Seats With
Tether Straps in this chapter.
*[SS16025(R)05/96]
When installing a child safety seat, be sure to use the correct
safety belt buckle for that seating position, and make sure the
tongue is securely fastened in the buckle. For a shoulder/lap
belt combination with a sliding tongue, make sure the retractor
is in the automatic locking mode.
*[SS16090(R)05/96]
All child restraint systems are designed to be secured in vehicle
seats by lap belts or by the lap portion of a lap-shoulder belt.
*[SS16250(R)01/96]
R WARNING
%
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight
of the child. Always follow the safety seat manufacturer’s
instructions when installing and using the safety seat.
Seatbacks should be upright for use with child safety
seats.
133
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS16280(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011286-A
[SS16300(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Always keep the buckle release button pointing upward
and away from the child seat, with the tongue button
between the child seat and the release button as shown
in the following illustration.
*[SS16370(R)03/96]
R WARNING
If you do not properly secure the safety seat, the child
occupying the seat may be injured during a collision or
sudden stop. An unsecured safety seat could also injure
other passengers.
134
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS16380(R)03/96]
R WARNING
Carefully follow all of the manufacturer’s instructions
included with the safety seat you put in your vehicle. If
you do not install and use the safety seat properly, the
child may be injured in a sudden stop or collision.
[SS16390(R)05/96]
R WARNING
Rear-facing infant seats should not be placed in the front
seat unless the passenger air bag deactivate switch is
turned to OFF. In rear-facing infant seats, the infant’s
head is closer to the passenger air bag. The force of the
rapidly inflating air bag could push the top of the
rear-facing seat against the vehicle seatback. Turning the
passenger air bag deactivate switch to OFF will prevent
the passenger air bag from deploying, avoiding any
interaction between the passenger air bag and the
rear-facing infant seat.
[SS16400(R)03/96]
Installing Child Safety Seats in Combination Lap and
Shoulder Belt Seating Positions
[SS16500(R)03/96]
1. Position the child safety seat in a seat with a combination
lap and shoulder belt.
[SS16510(R)03/96]
[SS16519(R)05/96]
If you choose to install a child safety seat in the front
passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible.
R WARNING
Keep the passenger air bag turned on unless there is a
rear-facing infant seat installed in the front seat. When
the passenger air bag switch is turned off, the passenger
air bag will not inflate in a collision.
135
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS16520(R)03/96]
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt and then grasp the shoulder
belt and lap belt together.
[SS16530(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011238-C
Pulling out belt webbing
136
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS16540(R)05/96]
3. While holding the shoulder and lap belt portions together,
route the tongue through the child seat according to the
child seat manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure the belt
webbing is not twisted.
[SS16550(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011239-C
Routing the lap/shoulder belt
137
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS16560(R)03/96]
4. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle for that seating
position until you hear and feel the latch engage. Make sure
the tongue is latched securely by pulling on it.
[SS16570(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011240-B
Buckling the belt
138
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS16580(R)03/96]
5. Grasp the shoulder portion of the belt and pull downward
until all of the belt retracted and a click is heard to put the
retractor in the automatic locking mode.
[SS16590(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011241-B
Setting the retractor to automatic locking mode
139
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS16600(R)03/96]
6. Allow the belt to retract. The belt will click as it retracts to
indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.
[SS16610(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011242-B
Allowing shoulder belt to retract
140
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
[SS16620(R)03/96]
7. Pull the lap belt portion across the child seat toward the
buckle and pull up on the shoulder belt while pushing down
on the child seat.
[SS16630(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011243-A
Removing slack from the belt
141
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
[SS16640(R)03/96]
8. Allow the safety belt to retract to remove any slack in the
belt.
[SS16650(R)03/96]
9. Before placing the child in the seat, forcibly tilt the seat
forward and back to make sure the seat is securely held in
place.
[SS16660(R)03/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0011244-B
[SS16670(R)03/96]
Checking that the seat is secure
10. Try to pull belt out of the retractor to make sure the
retractor is in the automatic locking mode (you should not
be able to pull more belt out). If the retractor is not locked,
unbuckle the belt and repeat steps 2 through 9.
[SS16680(R)03/96]
To remove the retractor from automatic locking mode, allow
webbing to retract fully to its stowed position and the retractor
will automatically switch back to the vehicle sensitive locking
mode for normal adult usage.
142
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS18400(R)04/96]
*[SS18410(R)01/96]
*[SS18413(R)04/96]
Attaching Safety Seats With Tether Straps
[SS18415(R)04/96]
You can attach a tether strap anchor bracket to the cab inner
back panel by using a tether anchor kit (613D74) available at no
charge from any Ford dealer.
[SS18420(R)01/96]
Read and follow the instructions provided with the kit carefully,
for installation of the child tether strap anchor.
*[SS18501(R)01/96]
Follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions to attach the
tether strap to the tether bracket.
*[SS18950(R)01/96]
WARNING
%
General Instructions
Some manufacturers make safety seats that include a tether
strap that goes over the back of the vehicle seat and attaches to
an anchoring point. Other manufacturers offer the tether strap
as an accessory. Contact the manufacturer of your child safety
seat for information about ordering a tether strap.
Only use the tether attachment hole locations shown in
the illustrations. The tether anchor may not perform
properly if the wrong mounting location is used.
143
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
*[SS19595(R)03/96]
In SuperCabs equipped with Center Facing Jump Seats, the
tether strap anchor bracket should be installed only at the center
of the cab’s back panel with the child seat in the front center
seating position. Installing an anchor bracket at the right rear of
the cab may increase risk of injury to an occupant of the right
rear center facing jump seat in the event of a collision or
sudden stop. If a tethered child seat is installed in the right
front seating position, secure the tether strap to the webbing of
the buckled right rear lap belt.
*[SS19600(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not install a child seat in a center facing jump seat.
*[SS19700(R)01/96]
*[SS19800(R)01/96]
%
Safety Belts for Children
Children who are too large for child safety seats should always
wear safety belts. (See instructions with your child seat, or
contact its manufacturer, to determine maximum size of child
that will safely fit in the seat.)
*[SS19900(R)01/96]
WARNING
If safety belts are not properly worn and adjusted as
described, the risk of serious injury to the child in a
collision will be much greater.
144
File:06unssr.ex
Update:Fri Mar 21 09:43:41 1997
Seating and Safety Restraints
*[SS20000(R)01/96]
If the shoulder belt portion of one of the lap and shoulder belts
can be positioned so that it does not cross or rest in front of the
child’s face or neck, the child should wear the lap and shoulder
belt. Moving the child closer to the center of the vehicle may
help provide a good shoulder belt fit.
*[SS20050(R)01/96]
To improve the fit of lap and shoulder belts on children who
have outgrown child safety seats, Ford recommends use of a
belt-positioning booster seat that is labelled as conforming to all
Federal motor vehicle safety standards. Belt-positioning booster
seats raise the child and provide a shorter, firmer seating
cushion that encourages safer seating posture and better fit of
lap and shoulder belts on the child. A belt-positioning booster
should be used if the shoulder belt rests in front of the child’s
face or neck, or if the lap belt does not fit snugly on both
thighs, or if the thighs are too short to let the child sit all the
way back on the seat cushion when the lower legs hang over
the edge of the seat cushion. You may wish to discuss the
specific needs of your child with your pediatrician.
*[SS20200(R)01/96]
Lap belts and the lap belt portion of lap and shoulder belts
should always be worn snugly and below the hips, touching the
child’s thighs.
*[SS20300(R)02/96]
WARNING
Children should always ride with the seatback in the
fully upright position.
145
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
Starting
*[TO04800(R)01/96]
*[TO04900(R)01/96]
Fuel-Injected Engines
*[TO04950(R)01/96]
% [TO05200(R)01/96]
*
*[TO05300(R)02/96]
Starting Your Vehicle
%
When starting a fuel-injected engine, the most important thing
to remember is to avoid pressing down on the accelerator
before or during starting. Only use the accelerator when you
have problems getting your vehicle started. See Starting Your
Engine in this chapter for details about when to use the
accelerator while you start your vehicle.
Preparing to Start Your Vehicle
WARNING
Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in other
enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open
the garage door before you start the engine.
*[TO05400(R)01/96]
*[TO05500(R)01/96]
Before you start your vehicle, do the following:
1. Make sure all occupants in the vehicle buckle their safety
belts. See Safety Restraints in the Index for more details.
*[TO05600(R)01/96]
2. Make sure the headlamps and other accessories are turned
*[TO05700(R)01/96]
3. If you have an automatic transmission, make sure that the
*[TO05800(R)01/96]
4. If you have a manual transmission, make sure that the
*[TO06000(R)02/96]
off when starting.
gearshift lever is in P (Park) and the parking brake is set
before you turn the key.
parking brake is fully set, push the clutch pedal to the floor,
and put the gearshift into Neutral before you turn the key.
(Remember, the starter will operate only if the clutch pedal
is pushed in all the way).
Before you start your vehicle, you should test the warning lights
on the instrument panel to make sure that they work. Refer to
the Instrumentation chapter.
147
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
*[TO06200(R)01/96]
*[TO06300(R)01/96]
*[TO06400(R)01/96]
%
Starting Your Engine
To start your engine:
1. Follow the steps under Preparing to Start Your Vehicle at the
beginning of this section.
*[TO06425(R)01/96]
*[TO06451(R)01/96]
2. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.
*[TO06475(R)01/96]
4. Turn the key to the START position (cranking) until the
3. DO NOT depress the accelerator pedal when starting your
engine. DO NOT use the accelerator while the vehicle is
parked.
engine starts. Allow the key to return to the ON position
after the engine has started.
*[TO06501(R)01/96]
If you have difficulty in turning the key, rotate the steering
wheel slightly because it may be binding.
*[TO06510(R)01/96]
*[TO06515(R)01/96]
For a cold engine:
*[TO06520(R)01/96]
■ At temperatures above 10˚F (-12˚C): If the engine does not
*[TO06521(R)01/96]
*[TO06522(R)01/96]
For a warm engine:
*[TO06575(R)01/96]
Whenever you start your vehicle, release the key as soon as the
engine starts. Excessive cranking could damage the starter.
%
%
■ At temperatures 10˚F (-12˚C) and below: If the engine does
not start in fifteen (15) seconds on the first try, turn the key
to OFF, wait approximately ten (10) seconds so you do not
flood the engine, then try again.
start in five (5) seconds on the first try, turn the key to OFF,
wait approximately ten (10) seconds so you do not flood the
engine, then try again.
■ Do not hold the key in the START position for more than
five (5) seconds at a time. If the engine does not start within
five (5) seconds on the first try, turn the key to the OFF
position. Wait a few seconds after the starter stops, then try
again.
148
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
Starting
*[TO06601(R)01/96]
After starting, allow the engine to idle for a few seconds before
driving away.
*[TO06775(R)01/96]
*[TO06825(R)01/96]
*[TO06851(R)01/96]
*[TO06876(R)01/96]
*[TO06900(R)01/96]
*[TO06925(R)03/96]
*[TO06951(R)05/96]
If the engine does not start after two attempts:
%
%
*[TO07300(R)01/96]
*[TO07390(R)01/96]
*[TO07400(R)01/96]
1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
2. Press the accelerator all the way to the floor and hold it.
3. Turn the ignition key to the START position.
4. Release the ignition key when the engine starts.
5. Release the accelerator gradually as the engine speeds up.
If the engine still does not start, the fuel pump shut-off switch
may have been activated. For directions on how to reset the
switch see Fuel Pump Shut-Off Switch in the index.
A computer system controls the engine’s idle speed. When you
start your vehicle, the engine’s idle speed normally runs high.
These faster engine speeds will make your vehicle coast slightly
faster than its normal idle speed. It should, however, slow down
after a short time. If it does not, have the idle speed checked.
If the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, do
not allow your vehicle to idle for more than 10 minutes. Have
the vehicle checked.
WARNING
Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce very
high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,
creating the risk of fire or other damage.
*[TO07450(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass or
other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up
the engine compartment and exhaust system, which can
start a fire.
149
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
*[TO07500(R)01/96]
%
*[TO07600(R)01/96]
[TO07700(R)04/96]
If you consistently start your vehicle in subzero temperatures,
use an engine block heater (if your vehicle has this option).
Engine Block Heater (If equipped)
Engine block heaters are strongly recommended if you live in a
region where temperatures reach s20˚F (s29˚C) or below
consistently during the winter months. An engine block heater
warms the engine coolant, which improves starting, warms up
the engine faster, and allows the heater-defrost system to
respond quickly.
*[TO08000(R)01/96]
WARNING
To prevent electrical shock, do not use your heater with
ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged (cheater)
adapters.
*[TO08100(R)01/96]
For best results, plug the heater in at least three hours before
you start your vehicle. Using the heater for longer than three
hours will not damage the engine, so you can plug it in at night
to start your vehicle the following morning.
*[TO08150(R)01/96]
NOTE: Be sure to disconnect the engine block heater before
driving your vehicle.
%
*[TO08175(R)01/96]
*[TO08200(R)05/96]
*[TO08210(R)03/96]
*[TO08215(R)03/96]
If the Engine Cranks but Does Not Start or
Does Not Start After a Collision
The Fuel Pump Shut-off Switch
If the engine cranks but does not start or does not start even
after a small collision, the fuel pump shut-off switch may have
been activated. The shut-off switch is a device intended to stop
the electric fuel pump when your vehicle has been involved in a
substantial jolt. Refer to the Roadside emergencies section for more
information.
Once the shut-off switch is activated, you must reset the switch
by hand before you can start your vehicle.
150
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
Starting
[TO08225(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Fuel pump shut-off switch location
art:0090157-A
*[TO08250(R)03/96]
WARNING
If you see or smell fuel, do not reset the switch or try to
start your vehicle. Have all the passengers get out of the
vehicle and call the local fire department or a towing
service.
*[TO08275(R)03/96]
If your engine cranks but does not start after a collision or
substantial jolt:
[TO08290(R)04/96]
1. Turn the key in the ignition to OFF.
*[TO08300(R)03/96]
*[TO08325(R)01/96]
2. Check under the vehicle for leaking fuel.
*[TO08350(R)01/96]
4. Turn the ignition key ON for a few seconds, then turn it
*[TO08375(R)03/96]
5. Check under the vehicle again for leaking fuel. If you see or
3. If you do not see or smell fuel, push the red reset button
down. If the button is already set, you may have a different
mechanical problem.
OFF.
smell fuel, do not start your vehicle again. If you do not
see or smell fuel, you can try to start your vehicle again.
151
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
*[TO08400(R)03/96]
6. Check all vehicle warning lights before driving your vehicle.
[TO08450(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021144-A
Reset button for fuel pump shut-off switch
*[TO09300(R)12/95]
*[TO09400(R)01/96]
Guarding Against Exhaust Fumes
Carbon monoxide, although colorless and odorless, is present in
exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid its dangerous effects.
*[TO09500(R)02/96]
WARNING
Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in other
enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open
the garage door before you start the engine.
*[TO09600(R)01/96]
WARNING
If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not
drive if you smell exhaust fumes.
*[TO09900(R)01/96]
Have the exhaust and body ventilation systems checked
whenever:
*[TO10000(R)01/96]
*[TO10100(R)01/96]
*[TO10200(R)01/96]
*[TO10300(R)01/96]
■ your vehicle is raised for service
■ the sound of the exhaust system changes
■ your vehicle has been damaged in a collision
Improve your ventilation by keeping all air inlet vents clear of
snow, leaves, and other debris.
152
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
Starting
*[TO10400(R)01/96]
If the engine is idling while you are stopped in an open area
for long periods of time, open the windows at least one inch
(2.5 cm). Also, adjust the heating or air conditioning system to
bring in outside air.
[TO10650(R)01/96]
■ HEATING — Set fan speed to medium or high, the function
control knob on any position except OFF and the
temperature control knob on any desired position.
[TO10700(R)01/96]
■ AIR CONDITIONING — Set fan speed to medium or high
with the function control knob on any position (except OFF
or MAX A/C) and the temperature control knob at a
comfortable level.
*[TO13076(R)03/96]
*[TO13100(R)03/96]
Removing the Key From the Ignition
[TO13117(R)01/96]
If you have a manual transmission, you have a key release lever
which allows you to remove your key from the ignition. The
key release lever is on the upper right of the steering column,
just above the key lock cylinder.
*[TO13300(R)03/96]
If your vehicle’s gearshift lever is mounted on the
column:
Procedures for removing your key from the ignition will vary,
depending on the type of gearshift your vehicle has. Gearshift
levers may be mounted on the steering column or on the floor
or console.
*[TO13400(R)03/96]
*[TO13500(R)03/96]
1. Put the gearshift in P (Park).
*[TO13600(R)03/96]
*[TO13700(R)03/96]
3. Turn the ignition key to LOCK.
2. Set the parking brake fully before removing your foot from
the service brake. (This will avoid “binding” or “loading” the
park gear if you park on a grade.)
4. Remove the key.
153
File:08untor.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:53:27 1997
*[TO13725(R)03/96]
If your vehicle’s gearshift lever is mounted on the
floor:
*[TO13750(R)03/96]
*[TO14000(R)03/96]
*[TO14100(R)03/96]
1. Put the gearshift in 1 (First).
*[TO14200(R)03/96]
*[TO14300(R)03/96]
*[TO14400(R)03/96]
*[TO14600(R)03/96]
4. Push and hold in the key release button.
2. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
3. Set the parking brake fully before removing your foot from
the service brake.
5. Turn the key to LOCK.
6. Remove the key.
WARNING
Always set the parking brake fully and make sure that
the gearshift is latched in P (Park) (automatic
transmission) or 1 (First) (manual transmission).
*[TO14750(R)03/96]
WARNING
Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets
unattended in your vehicle.
154
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF00100(R)05/96]
*[GF00200(R)01/96]
*[GF00210(R)01/96]
Brakes
*[GF00270(R)03/96]
*[GF00274(R)03/96]
Rear Drum Brakes
*[GF00300(R)01/96]
Hydraulic Power Brakes
[GF00310(R)01/96]
The hydraulic brake system is made up of two independent
hydraulic circuits. One hydraulic circuit supplies fluid to the
front disc brakes and the other hydraulic circuit supplies fluid
to the rear drum or disc brakes. These two circuits are supplied
by a common hydraulic brake fluid reservoir, with a fluid level
sensor.
[GF01010( ALL)03/97]
Occasional brake noise is normal and does not indicate a
performance concern with the vehicle’s brake system. In normal
operation, automotive brake systems may emit occasional or
intermittent squeal or groan noises when the brakes are applied.
Such noises are usually heard during the first few brake
applications in the morning; however, they may be heard at any
time while braking and can be aggravated by environmental
conditions such as cold, heat, moisture, road dust, salt or mud.
If a “metal-to-metal” or “continuous grinding” sound is present
while braking, the brake linings may be worn-out and should be
inspected by a qualified service technician.
*[GF00312(R)01/96]
The brake light in the instrument cluster will light for low brake
fluid in the common brake fluid reservoir.
%
Front Disc Brakes
The front disc brakes are self-adjusting. They do not require
service other than periodic inspection for pad wear.
The rear drum brakes are self-adjusting. Automatic adjustment
occurs when the brakes are applied while “backing up.” If
normal operation does not include much backing, adjust the
brakes when they seem “low,” using the procedure under If
Brakes Do Not Grip Well or Pedal is “Low” in this chapter.
155
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF00350(R)01/96]
WARNING
An increase in pedal travel will result in reduced braking
capability. The brake system should be checked
immediately.
%
*[GF00400(R)01/96]
Rear Anti-lock Brakes
[GF00410(R)04/96]
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Rear Anti-lock Brake
System. This system prevents at least one and often both rear
wheels from completely locking up when the brakes are applied
in a panic stop, for example.
[GF015100( ALL)03/97]
On vehicles equipped with an antilock braking system (ABS), a
noise from the hydraulic pump motor and pulsation in the
pedal may be observed during ABS braking events. Pedal
pulsation coupled with noise while braking under panic
conditions or on loose gravel, wet or snowy roads is normal
and indicates proper functioning of the vehicle’s antilock brake
system. If the vehicle has continuous vibration or shudder while
braking, felt mainly in the steering wheel, the vehicle most
likely needs service.
*[GF00420(R)01/96]
Even with the Anti-lock Brake System, you should be careful
when braking. Front brake lock up on any surface, even on
smooth pavement causes loss of steering control. Heavy braking
on roads with loose surfaces such as snow or gravel, or severe
pavement irregularities could also cause you to lose steering
control of your vehicle.
*[GF00450(R)03/96]
WARNING
If the anti-lock brake system warning light remains on or
comes on while driving, have the braking system checked
by a qualified service technician as soon as possible.
156
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF00460(R)03/96]
NOTE: If a fault occurs in the anti-lock system, and the brake
warning light is not lit, the anti-lock system is
disabled but normal brake function remains
operational.
[GF00470(R)01/96]
Four Wheel Anti-lock Brake System
[GF00474(R)04/96]
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Four Wheel Anti-lock
Braking System (4WABS). The 4WABS helps the driver to
maintain vehicle control by preventing wheel lockup during
hard braking.
[GF00476(R)04/96]
The 4WABS operates with a computer that is able to optimize
vehicle control during braking on varying tire and road
conditions by modulating the brake pressure at each of the front
wheels and the rear axle. This “pumping action” is similar to
the driver “pumping” the brakes but happens at a much faster
rate.
[GF00500(R)04/96]
WARNING
The Anti-lock system does NOT assist the vehicle in
stopping quickly on wet or icy surfaces. Heavy braking
combined with poor road conditions could cause you to
lose steering control of your vehicle.
[GF00550(R)04/96]
Using anti-lock brakes
[GF00552(R)04/96]
The operation of a vehicle with 4WABS is not similar to the
operation of normal brakes. Some differences exist and are listed
below:
[GF00554(R)04/96]
■ Apply the brake steadily. In the event of a panic stop, do
NOT “pump” the brakes. “Pumping” the brakes during an
Anti-lock stop will diminish braking effectiveness.
% [GF00558(R)04/96]
■ During an Anti-lock stop, the driver will notice a brake
pedal pulsation and hear some noise from the engine
compartment. This is an indication that the 4WABS system is
working correctly and is normal.
157
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF00560(R)04/96]
WARNING
The Anti-lock system does NOT decrease the time
necessary to apply the brakes. Always leave enough room
between the vehicle in front of you and your vehicle.
[GF00570(R)04/96]
4WABS driver warning light
[GF00572(R)01/96]
The 4WABS computer continuously monitors the system while
driving for any electrical faults or system malfunctions. In
addition, the 4WABS computer performs an initial system check
called bulb proveout when the vehicle ignition is switched on.
During bulb proveout, the ABS light on the instrument cluster
will momentarily illuminate and then go out.
[GF00574(R)04/96]
NOTE: After starting the vehicle and upon initial drive-off,
the driver may notice a single pulse of the brake
pedal and a noise from the engine compartment. This
is part of the initial system check and is normal.
[GF00576(R)01/96]
Should a malfunction in the 4WABS system occur, the ABS light
on the instrument cluster will come on and stay on indicating
that the anti-lock system has been shut down and the vehicle
needs to be serviced. Normal braking is not affected unless the
brake warning light is also illuminated.
[GF00578(R)04/96]
NOTE: It is important to note that when the ABS Warning
Light is illuminated the ABS system is disabled. The
vehicle must be serviced immediately to restore the
benefits of the Anti-lock system.
[GF00580(R)04/96]
NOTE: Mobile phones or radio transmitters not installed by
Ford Motor Company may interfere with the Anti-lock
System. Should the Anti-lock system activate
unexpectedly or the Anti-lock Warning Light
illuminate after installation of such a unit, have the
installation of the unit checked.
158
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF00600(R)03/96]
% [GF00610(R)03/96]
*
If Brakes Do Not Grip Well or Pedal is “Low”
*[GF00630(R)01/96]
If during normal operation the brake pedal seems “low”, it may
indicate the need for a brake system inspection and/or service.
You should have your brakes checked as soon as possible.
%
%
*[GF00640(R)01/96]
If brakes do not grip well, it may indicate the rear drum brakes
need adjustment. To do this, drive the vehicle in reverse at
5 mph (8 km/h) on level, dry pavement. Stop the vehicle by
firmly applying the brakes. Repeat this procedure four or five
times.
Occasional brake squeal during light to moderate stops does not
affect the function of the brake system and is normal. However,
if the squeal becomes louder or more frequent, have your
brakes inspected by your dealer or a qualified service technician.
*[GF00650(R)03/96]
WARNING
Modifications to the suspension spring rates and/or
vehicle ride height may adversely affect vehicle stopping
ability.
*[GF00670(R)03/96]
*[GF00672(R)03/96]
*[GF00674(R)03/96]
*[GF00678(R)03/96]
If Brakes Pull
[GF00700(R)01/96]
*[GF00710(R)01/96]
*
Stopping Distances
%
■ Check tire pressure.
■ Perform the self-adjustment procedure described under If
Brakes Do Not Grip Well or Pedal is “Low.”
If pull occurs during the first 500 miles (800 km), make 10
moderately fast stops from 40 mph (65 km/h) and then
perform the self-adjustment procedure above. It may be
necessary to repeat this operation to properly seat new brake
linings and pads.
Stopping distances vary with different loads and driving
conditions. Use caution when encountering new conditions and
acquaint yourself with vehicle performance. Take full advantage
of engine braking power when slowing down.
159
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF00720(R)01/96]
*[GF00722(R)01/96]
Applying the Brakes
*[GF00724(R)01/96]
Do not drive with your foot resting on the brake pedal. This
will increase your vehicle’s stopping distance and may also
cause brake damage.
%
Apply the brake pedal gradually. Use the “squeeze” technique
— push on the brake pedal with a steadily increasing force. This
allows the wheels to continue to roll while you are slowing
down, which lets you steer properly.
*[GF00740(R)01/96]
WARNING
If you are driving down a long or steep hill, shift to a
lower gear. Do not apply your brakes continuously, as
they may overheat and become less effective.
*[GF00750(R)05/96]
*[GF00752(R)03/96]
Using the Parking Brake
*[GF00753(R)01/96]
The parking brake pedal is suspended just below the bottom of
the instrument panel to the left of service brake and/or clutch
pedals. To set the parking brake while parking your vehicle,
press the brake pedal with your right foot and hold it while
you push the parking brake pedal down firmly and fully with
your left foot.
%
The parking brake should be used whenever you park your
vehicle.
160
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF00760(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020568-D
*[GF00770(R)03/96]
Parking brake
WARNING
Always set the parking brake fully and make sure that
the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) (automatic
transmission) or in 1 (First) (manual transmission).
*[GF00775(R)05/96]
*[GF00780(R)05/96]
With the transfer case in N (Neutral), the vehicle is free to move
with either the automatic transmission in P (Park) or with the
manual transmission in any driving gear.
WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
161
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF00785(R)05/96]
To release the parking brake, press the brake pedal with your
right foot and hold the parking brake pedal down with your
left foot while you pull the parking brake release lever. Lift
your foot from the parking brake pedal after it is released.
*[GF00790(R)02/96]
WARNING
If the parking brake is fully released, but the Brake
System light remains on, have the brakes checked
immediately. They may not be working properly.
*[GF00795(R)03/96]
%
*[GF00800(R)01/96]
[GF00810(R)01/96]
%
*[GF00830(R)03/96]
*[GF00840(R)01/96]
*[GF00850(R)01/96]
The parking brake is not designed to stop a moving vehicle, but
you can use the parking brake to stop your vehicle in an
emergency if the normal brakes fail. However, since the parking
brake applies only the rear brakes, the stopping distance will
increase greatly and the handling of your vehicle will be
adversely affected.
Steering Your Vehicle
Your Ranger may have optional power steering. Power steering
uses energy from the engine to help steer your vehicle.
If the amount of effort needed to steer your vehicle changes at a
constant vehicle speed, have the power steering system checked.
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is
turned off), you can steer the vehicle manually but it takes more
effort.
Never hold the steering wheel to the extreme right or left for
more than five seconds if the engine is running. This can
damage the power steering pump.
NOTE: After any severe impact such as striking large
potholes, sliding into curbs on icy roads, or a collision
involving the front end, observe the steering wheel
alignment. If the spokes of the steering wheel seem to
be in a different position while going straight down
the road, have the front suspension and steering
checked for possible damage.
162
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF00900(R)05/96]
Automatic Transmission Operation
(4R44E/5R55E)
[GF08715(R)05/96]
If your vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, it
will be either a four speed overdrive transmission (4R44E) or a
five speed overdrive transmission (5R55E). All 2.3L and 3.0L
engines use the 4R44E transmission, while all 4.0L engines use
the 5R55E transmission. Both transmission types have a lockup
torque converter. Transmission operation is controlled by the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
*[GF08720(R)01/96]
The PCM will automatically adjust transmission operation to
make up for varying conditions. Several sensors located on the
engine and transmission such as throttle position, engine speed,
vehicle speed and transmission temperature are used by the
PCM to shift the transmission into a higher or lower gear when
required for the best performance and fuel economy. For
example, you may notice that the transmission will upshift to a
higher gear more quickly when the vehicle has not reached
normal operating temperature.
*[GF08730(R)01/96]
The PCM also controls the transmission’s Torque Converter
Clutch (TCC) to further raise vehicle performance and fuel
economy. The TCC will engage when the transmission operating
temperature and other conditions determined by the PCM have
been met. Engagement of the clutch may be noted as a decrease
in engine speed.
[GF08740(R)05/96]
To help in troubleshooting, the PCM continually performs
self-tests on the electronic control system and, if any faults are
detected, stores them in memory. The Transmission Control
Indicator Light (TCIL) (O/D OFF), which is located on the
instrument cluster, may flash steadily if a malfunction has been
detected. If the TCIL is flashing, contact your Ford dealer as
soon as possible. If this condition persists, damage to the
transmission could occur.
163
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF08742(R)05/96]
Speed limiter
[GF08744(R)05/96]
All models are equipped with a Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) which limits the maximum engine speed and thus road
speed in top gear. Vehicle operation is normal since the
controlled maximum speed is above posted highway speeds in
North America.
*[GF08746(R)05/96]
*[GF08748(R)05/96]
Power Braking
*[GF08749(R)05/96]
NOTE: Continued operation in the stall condition can result
in transmission overheat, malfunction or fluid
expulsion.
*[GF08752(R)05/96]
% [GF08755(R)05/96]
*
Automatic Overdrive Transmission
[GF08800(R)01/96]
Your vehicle’s gearshift is on the steering column. The
transmission control switch is located on the end of the gearshift
lever. You can put the gearshift in any of the several positions.
Increasing the engine speed above idle without vehicle
movement (such as holding the brake) in a forward or reverse
gear causes transmission stall.
Putting Your Vehicle in Gear
[GF08915(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
The positions of the column-mounted gearshift
art:0021373-A
164
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF08925(R)01/96]
quarter page
art:0021255-A
Transmission control switch (located on the end of the gearshift lever)
*[GF09000(R)05/96]
WARNING
Hold the brake pedal down while you move the gearshift
lever from position to position. If you do not hold the
brake pedal down, your vehicle may move unexpectedly
and injure someone.
*[GF09100(R)05/96]
%
*[GF09110(R)05/96]
Once you place the gearshift securely into position, gradually
release the brake pedal and use the accelerator as necessary.
NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock
feature. This feature prevents you from shifting from
P (Park) unless you have the brake pedal depressed.
(The ignition must be in the ON position.) If you
cannot shift from P (Park) with the brake pedal
depressed:
*[GF09120(R)05/96]
*[GF09130(R)05/96]
*[GF09140(R)05/96]
1. Apply the parking brake.
*[GF09150(R)05/96]
4. Apply the brake pedal and shift to N (Neutral). (If the
*[GF09160(R)05/96]
5. Start the vehicle.
2. Remove the key.
3. Insert the key and rotate it one position clockwise (ignition
in the OFF position).
vehicle is shifted back to P [Park], you must repeat the
previous steps.)
165
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF09165(R)05/96]
If you need to shift out of P (Park) by using the alternate
procedure described above, it is possible that a fuse has blown
and that your brakelamps may also not be functional. Please
refer to the chapter titled Roadside Emergencies in this Owner
Guide for instructions on checking and replacing fuses.
*[GF09170(R)05/96]
WARNING
DO NOT DRIVE YOUR VEHICLE UNTIL YOU VERIFY
THAT THE BRAKELAMPS ARE WORKING.
*[GF09175(R)05/96]
P (Park)
[GF09180(R)05/96]
Always come to a complete stop before you shift into P (Park).
This position locks the transmission and prevents the rear
wheels from turning.
[GF09189(R)05/96]
To securely latch the gearshift in the P (Park) position, pull it
toward you, push it completely counterclockwise against the
stop, and then push it toward the instrument panel.
*[GF09190(R)05/96]
The gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) if you cannot rotate
it in a clockwise direction without lifting it toward you.
*[GF09195(R)05/96]
WARNING
Always set the parking brake fully and make sure the
gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn off the ignition
whenever you leave your vehicle.
*[GF09197(R)05/96]
WARNING
Never leave your vehicle unattended while it is running.
*[GF09200(R)05/96]
*[GF09300(R)05/96]
%
R (Reverse)
With the gearshift in the R (Reverse) position, the vehicle will
move backward. You should always come to a complete stop
before shifting into or out of R (Reverse).
166
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF09350(R)01/96]
*[GF09375(R)01/96]
N (Neutral)
*[GF09380(R)05/96]
With the transfer case in N (Neutral), the vehicle is free to move
with either the automatic transmission in P (Park) or with the
manual transmission in any driving gear.
With the gearshift in the N (Neutral) position, the vehicle can be
started and is free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in
this position.
*[GF09385(R)05/96]
WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
[GF09400(R)05/96]
%
*[GF09500(R)05/96]
[GF09600(R)05/96]
Driving (4R44E Transmission)
When to use j (Overdrive)
This is the normal driving position. As the vehicle picks up
speed, automatic upshifts to second, third and fourth gears will
occur when j (Overdrive) is chosen on the selector and the
transmission control switch has not been pressed. The
transmission will shift into the correct gear when the right
speed is achieved, for the accelerator pedal position you have
chosen.
*[GF09700(R)05/96]
When to use Drive
[GF09800(R)01/96]
You will note there is not a drive position on your gearshift
indicator. However, you will find a transmission control switch
labeled O/D ON/OFF located on the end of the gearshift lever.
Press this switch and the O/D OFF indicator light will
illuminate on the instrument cluster. With overdrive cancelled
and the O/D OFF indicator light illuminated, the transmission
will operate in gears one through three. This is useful if you
experience frequent downshift/upshift conditions, when
operating with a heavy load or in hilly terrain, or if additional
167
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
engine braking is useful. However, shift back to j (Overdrive)
whenever practical for optimum powertrain cooling and fuel
economy. This can be accomplished by pushing the transmission
control switch again, to cancel the O/D OFF control and light.
[GF09850(R)01/96]
quarter page
art:0021255-A
Transmission control switch (located on the end of the gearshift lever)
*[GF09950(R)01/96]
When starting your vehicle, the overdrive system will
automatically be in the normal overdrive mode.
*[GF10100(R)05/96]
*[GF10200(R)05/96]
When to use 2 (Second)
*[GF10300(R)05/96]
*[GF10400(R)05/96]
When to use 1 (Low)
*[GF10402(R)05/96]
*[GF10404(R)05/96]
Forced Downshifts
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide
additional engine braking on downgrades. This position
provides 2 (Second) gear operation only.
Use 1 (Low) to provide maximum engine braking on steep
downgrades. Upshifts from 1 (Low) can be made by manually
shifting to 2 (Second) or j (Overdrive). Selection of 1 (Low)
gear provides only low gear operation from start-up. Selection
of 1 (Low) while at higher speeds provides a shift to second
gear, and a shift to first gear will occur after the vehicle
decelerates to the proper speed.
To gain extra acceleration in j (Overdrive) or Drive (O/D
OFF), push the accelerator to the floor. The transmission will
automatically downshift to the appropriate gear: third, second
or first.
168
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF10410(R)05/96]
Driving (5R55E Transmission)
%
*[GF10419(R)05/96]
*[GF10420(R)05/96]
When to use j (Overdrive)
This is the normal driving position. As the vehicle picks up
speed, automatic upshifts to second, third, fourth and fifth gears
will occur when j (Overdrive) is chosen on the selector and
the transmission control switch has not been pressed. The
transmission will shift into the correct gear when the right
speed is achieved, for the accelerator pedal position you have
chosen.
*[GF10429(R)05/96]
When to use Drive
[GF10430(R)05/96]
You will note there is not a drive position on your gearshift
indicator. However, you will find a transmission control switch
labeled OD ON/OFF located on the end of the gearshift lever.
With overdrive canceled and the OD ON/OFF illuminated, the
transmission will operate in gears one through four. This is
useful if you experience frequent downshift/upshift conditions,
when operating a heavy load or in hilly terrain, or if additional
engine braking is useful. However, shift back to j (Overdrive)
whenever practical for optimum powertrain cooling and fuel
economy. This can be accomplished by pushing the transmission
control switch again, to cancel the OVERDRIVE OFF control and
light.
*[GF10435(R)05/96]
*[GF10440(R)05/96]
When to use 2 (Second)
With the gearshift in the 2 (Second) position, more engine
braking is provided. Use the 2 (Second) position to drive up
moderately steep grades, to start up slippery roads, or to
provide moderate engine braking on downgrades. DO NOT GO
FASTER THAN 55 mph (88 km/h) IN THIS GEARSHIFT
POSITION.
169
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF10445(R)05/96]
*[GF10450(R)05/96]
When to use 1 (Low)
*[GF10455(R)05/96]
Forced Downshifts
[GF10460(R)05/96]
To gain acceleration in j (Overdrive) or Drive (O/D OFF)
when passing another vehicle, push the accelerator to the floor.
The transmission will downshift to the appropriate gear: fourth,
third, second or first gear.
*[GF10490(R)05/96]
*[GF10492(R)05/96]
Traction-Lok Rear Axle (If equipped)
*[GF10494(R)03/96]
Extended use of other than matching size tires on a
Traction-Lok rear axle could result in a permanent reduction in
effectiveness. This loss of effectiveness does not affect normal
driving and should not be noticeable to the driver.
[GF11300(R)01/96]
Manual Transmission Operation
*[GF11400(R)01/96]
*[GF11500(R)01/96]
Using the Clutch
%
%
With the gearshift in the 1 (First) position, maximum engine
braking is provided. This position provides 1 (First) gear
operation only with no automatic upshifts. To obtain upshifts,
the gearshift must be moved out of this position. Use the 1
(First) position to drive up steep grades or to provide maximum
engine braking on downgrades.
This axle provides added drive away traction on slippery
surfaces, particularly when one or more wheels are on a surface
with poor traction.
Make sure the gearshift lever is in the N (Neutral) position and
your right foot is holding down the brake pedal. Then press the
clutch pedal to the floor with your left foot. Manual
transmission vehicles have a starter interlock switch. The starter
will not crank until the clutch pedal is fully depressed. Start the
engine and allow it to idle for a few seconds. Move the
gearshift into 1 (First) or R (Reverse).
170
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF11600(R)01/96]
To move the vehicle, release the clutch slowly and at the same
time press down slowly on the accelerator so that the vehicle
accelerates.
*[GF11700(R)01/96]
Do not drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal and do
not use the clutch to hold your vehicle at a standstill while
waiting on a hill. These actions will seriously reduce clutch life.
*[GF11750(R)01/96]
Driving with your foot resting on the clutch may cause the
vehicle to jerk sharply when pressing or removing your other
foot from the accelerator.
*[GF11800(R)01/96]
*[GF11900(R)01/96]
Shifting the Gears
%
The gearshift for a manual transmission is mounted on the floor.
The gearshift pattern consists of seven positions: Neutral, five
forward gears, and Reverse.
[GF12000(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021180-B
5-Speed Overdrive manual transmission shift pattern
*[GF12300(R)01/96]
*[GF12400(R)01/96]
*[GF12501(R)01/96]
*[GF12551(R)01/96]
Backing up
To shift into R (Reverse):
1. Push the clutch pedal in all the way to the floor and hold it.
If you do not hold the clutch pedal in all the way, you may
hear a grinding noise when you shift.
2. Bring your vehicle to a complete stop. Failure to do so may
cause synchronizer teeth damage, reducing the useful life of
your transmission.
171
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF12600(R)01/96]
3. Put the gearshift in Neutral and wait at least 3 seconds
*[GF12700(R)01/96]
4. Push the gearshift all the way to the right and pull it back
before shifting into R (Reverse) to prevent a grinding noise.
Do not release the clutch.
into Reverse.
*[GF12800(R)01/96]
With the 5-speed transmission you can engage R (Reverse) only
by moving the gearshift from the left of 3 (Third) and 4 (Fourth)
gears before you shift into R (Reverse). This is a special lockout
feature that protects you from accidentally shifting into R when
you downshift from 5 (Fifth) gear.
*[GF12900(R)01/96]
5. Once R (Reverse) is engaged, slowly release the clutch pedal
*[GF13000(R)01/96]
If R (Reverse) is not engaged, continue to push the clutch pedal
in while you put the gearshift back into Neutral. Then, release
the clutch pedal for a moment and repeat steps 2 through 5.
*[GF13100(R)01/96]
Upshifting/downshifting
[GF13200(R)03/96]
Upshift and downshift at the speeds that are specified in the
charts.
from the floor.
172
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
%
*[GF13250(R)01/96]
[GF14950(R)01/96]
Recommended Shift Speeds
Engines with 5-Speed Manual Overdrive Transmission
[GF15000(R)01/96]
thirty pica
chart:0021181-E
173
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF15100(R)03/96]
When you slow down or climb a steep hill, always downshift
before the engine starts to lose power. Downshifting reduces the
chance of stalling and gives your vehicle better acceleration to
increase speed again.
*[GF15200(R)01/96]
When you drive down steep hills, downshifting helps you keep
a safe speed and helps prevent unnecessary wear on the brakes.
*[GF15300(R)01/96]
When you come to a stop, do not downshift through each gear.
Disengage the clutch and use the brake as necessary.
Downshifting through the gears decreases your vehicle’s fuel
economy.
*[GF15400(R)01/96]
WARNING
Continued use of a damaged or worn clutch, prolonged
clutch slippage or downshifting at excessive speeds can
result in a failure of the engine, transmission or clutch
components.
*[GF15500(R)01/96]
Transmission Function
[GF15600(R)01/96]
Upshift at the speeds specified in the chart. All forward gears
are synchronized allowing you to shift into them with your
vehicle in motion. The clutch pedal should be fully depressed
when shifting.
*[GF15625(R)03/96]
NOTE: Shifting during extremely low RPMs can result in a
momentary audible rattle which disappears as vehicle
RPMs are increased. Shifting at higher speeds will
eliminate this sound.
*[GF15700(R)01/96]
*[GF15800(R)01/96]
Parking
To park your vehicle, apply the service brake pedal, and shift
into N (Neutral) while still maintaining pressure on the service
brake. Set the parking brake fully. Shift into first and turn off
the ignition.
174
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF15900(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not park your vehicle in Neutral, it may move
unexpectedly and injure someone. Use 1 (First) gear and
set the parking brake fully.
*[GF15903(R)05/96]
*[GF15906(R)05/96]
With the transfer case in N (Neutral), the vehicle is free to move
with either the automatic transmission in P (Park) or with the
manual transmission in any driving gear.
WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
%
*[GF16101(R)01/96]
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) System
(If equipped)
[GF16130(R)01/96]
When you select the 4WD mode, your vehicle uses all four
wheels to power itself. This increases traction, enabling you to
drive your 4x4 over terrain and road conditions not travelled
normally by two-wheel drive vehicles.
*[GF16160(R)01/96]
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case that
allows you to select four-wheel drive when necessary. Methods
for engaging and disengaging 4WD and low range will depend
on which system your vehicle has.
[GF16170(R)05/96]
4WD Systems — Select Drive Electric Shift
[GF16180(R)05/96]
The select drive electric shift system functions in three modes.
In two-wheel drive mode, power is delivered only to the rear
axle at normal road speed. The 4x4 HIGH position provides
four-wheel drive with power delivered to the front and rear
axles for increased traction. The 4x4 LOW position provides
four-wheel drive with power delivered to the front and rear
axles when above average power is required at reduced speeds.
175
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF16190(R)05/96]
Four-wheel drive operation (4x4 HIGH or 4x4 LOW) on dry
pavement is not recommended. Operating the vehicle in
four-wheel drive on dry pavement will increase noise, vibration,
tire wear, decrease fuel economy, and make four-wheel drive
disengagement difficult for the transfer case.
[GF16200(R)05/96]
Electric shift system indicator lights
[GF16210(R)05/96]
A 4WD indicator light and a 4WD LOW indicator light are
located in the instrument cluster. If either light flashes, take
your vehicle in for service.
[GF16220(R)05/96]
■ Two-Wheel Drive mode — Neither the 4WD nor the 4WD
LOW lights are lit.
[GF16230(R)05/96]
■ 4WD High — Only the 4WD light is lit.
[GF16240(R)05/96]
■ 4WD LOW mode — Both the 4WD and 4WD LOW lights
are lit.
[GF16250(R)05/96]
To shift from Two-Wheel Drive to 4WD High:
[GF16260(R)05/96]
To shift into 4WD High rotate the 4WD switch located on the
instrument panel to 4x4 High. This shift can be done at a stop
or at speeds up to 55 miles per hour (88 km/h). When the
vehicle is driven, the automatic locking hubs will engage. If the
vehicle is stopped while in 4WD and the vehicle direction is
reversed from the previous direction, the automatic locking hubs
will momentarily disengage and re-engage. The automatic
locking hubs may click as they automatically engage in the new
direction.
176
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF16270(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
Select drive rotary switch
art:0020628-D
[GF16280(R)05/96]
At extremely low temperatures, it may be necessary to slow
down or even stop to shift from two wheel drive to 4WD.
[GF16290(R)05/96]
The initial shift from two-wheel drive to 4WD while the vehicle
is moving can cause some momentary clunk and ratcheting
sounds. This is the front drivetrain coming up to speed and the
automatic locking hubs engaging and is not a cause for concern.
[GF16300(R)05/96]
Because of possible damage to powertrain components, never
shift from two-wheel drive to 4WD with the rear wheels
slipping.
[GF16310(R)05/96]
To shift from 4WD High to Two-Wheel Drive:
[GF16320(R)05/96]
Rotate the 4WD switch to 2WD; the 4WD light on the
instrument cluster will go out, indicating the vehicle is in
two-wheel drive. This can be done at any speed. To disengage
the automatic locking hubs, operate the vehicle in two-wheel
drive in the opposite direction for approximately 10 feet (3
meters) in a straight line.
177
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF16330(R)05/96]
For example:
[GF16340(R)05/96]
If you were driving the vehicle forward in 4WD, the
automatic locking hubs will disengage the next time the
vehicle is driven in reverse in two-wheel drive for
approximately 10 feet (3 meters) in a straight line.
[GF16350(R)05/96]
If you were driving the vehicle in reverse in 4WD, the
automatic locking hubs will disengage the next time the
vehicle is driven forward in two-wheel drive for
approximately 10 feet (3 meters) in a straight line.
*[GF16360(R)05/96]
Operating in two-wheel drive mode with the hubs locked
increases fuel consumption, noise, vibration, and wear. For
prolonged two-wheel drive operation on dry pavement,
disengagement of the automatic locking hubs, which is not
required for two-wheel drive operation, stops all movement of
front-wheel drive components while operating in two-wheel
drive.
[GF16370(R)05/96]
During axle break-in or operation in extremely cold
temperatures, the automatic locking hubs may not release
completely. It may be necessary to drive the vehicle for 10 to 15
minutes before repeating the release procedure.
[GF16380(R)05/96]
To shift from 4x4 HIGH or 2WD to 4x4 LOW:
[GF16390(R)05/96]
Stop the vehicle, depress the brake and place the automatic
transmission in N (Neutral) or depress the clutch on vehicles
with a manual transmission. Rotate the 4WD switch on the
instrument panel to 4x4 LOW. Both the 4WD and 4WD LOW
lights are now lit.
178
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF16400(R)05/96]
To shift from 4x4 LOW to 4x4 HIGH or 2WD:
[GF16410(R)05/96]
Stop the vehicle, depress the brake and place the automatic
transmission into N (Neutral) or depress the clutch on vehicles
with a manual transmission. Rotate the 4WD switch on the
instrument panel to 4x4 HIGH or 2WD.
[GF16420(R)05/96]
It is not recommended to operate the vehicle in the 4WD modes
with a temporary spare. If 4WD operation is necessary, do not
operate at speeds above 10 mph or for distances above 50 miles.
Extended operation in 4WD with a temporary spare may result
in damage to drivetrain components.
*[GF17000(R)05/96]
*[GF17010(R)05/96]
4x4 Systems — Lever Operated
%
The lever operated transfer case can be placed into four
positions. The 2H position is the two-wheel drive position in
which power is delivered only to the rear axle. The 4H position
provides four-wheel drive with power delivered to the front
and rear axles for increased traction. The 4L position provides
four-wheel drive with power delivered to the front and rear
axles when the above average power is required at reduced
speeds. In the N (neutral) position, there is no power delivered
to either axle.
179
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF17020(R)05/96]
24 pica art:0090170-A
Transfer case selections
*[GF17030(R)05/96]
Four-wheel drive operation (4H or 4L) on dry pavement is not
recommended. Operating the vehicle in four-wheel drive on dry
pavement will increase tire wear, decrease fuel economy, and
make four-wheel drive disengagement difficult for the transfer
case.
180
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF17040(R)05/96]
4WD system indicator lights
[GF17050(R)05/96]
A 4WD light and a 4WD LOW light are located in the
instrument cluster.
[GF17060(R)05/96]
■ 2H position — Neither the 4WD or the 4WD LOW lights are
lit.
[GF17070(R)05/96]
■ 4H position — Only the 4WD light is lit.
[GF17080(R)05/96]
■ N position — Neither the 4WD or 4WD LOW lights are lit.
[GF17090(R)05/96]
■ 4L position — Both the 4WD and the 4WD LOW lights are
lit.
*[GF17100(R)05/96]
*[GF17110(R)05/96]
To shift from 2H to 4H:
Stop the vehicle and engage the manual locking hubs by
turning both hub lock selector knobs clockwise to the LOCK
position. Move the transfer case shift lever straight back to the
4H position. After both hubs have been turned to the LOCK
position, shifts between 2H and 4H (or 4H to 2H) may take
place at any speed.
[GF17120(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
Locking hub positions
art:0021182-A
[GF17130(R)05/96]
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle in 4H or 4L with the manual
locking hubs in the FREE position.
181
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF17140(R)05/96]
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with the left and right
manual locking hubs set to different positions.
*[GF17150(R)05/96]
*[GF17160(R)05/96]
To shift from 4H to 2H:
*[GF17170(R)05/96]
Operating in 2H with the hubs in the LOCK position increases
fuel consumption, noise, vibration, and wear. For prolonged 2H
operation on dry pavement, set the manual locking hubs to the
FREE position.
*[GF17180(R)05/96]
To shift between 4H and 4L:
[GF17190(R)05/96]
Stop the vehicle and place the automatic transmission into N
(Neutral) or depress the clutch on vehicles with a manual
transmission. Pull the transfer case shift lever to the left and
shift the transfer case to the desired 4H or 4L position. This
shift should be with one continuous motion without pausing in
the N position. Pausing in the neutral position can result in gear
clash and difficult shifting. If while shifting between 4H and 4L,
the transfer case gets stuck in the N position or is difficult to
shift into either 4H or 4L, it may be necessary to let the vehicle
roll slightly and/or turn off the engine (particularly on vehicles
equipped with automatic transmissions).
[GF17200(R)05/96]
To shift between N (Neutral) and either 4H or 4L
[GF17210(R)05/96]
To shift into N (Neutral), stop the vehicle and engage the
parking brake. Place the automatic transmission into N (Neutral)
or depress the clutch on manual transmission vehicles. From
either the 4H or 4L position, pull the transfer case shift lever to
the left and move the transfer case shift lever to the N (Neutral)
position. The N (Neutral) position should only be used for
vehicle towing.
Move the transfer case shift lever forward to the 2H position.
This can be done at any speed. However, the front driveline
will remain engaged to the front wheels until the manual
locking hubs are disengaged. To disengage the manual locking
hubs, stop the vehicle and rotate both hub lock selector knobs
counterclockwise to the FREE position.
182
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF17220(R)05/96]
*[GF17230(R)05/96]
With the transfer case in N (Neutral), the vehicle is free to move
with either the automatic transmission in P (Park) or with the
manual transmission in any driving gear.
WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
*[GF17240(R)05/96]
To shift from N (Neutral) to either 4H or 4L, stop the vehicle
and engage the parking brake. Place the automatic transmission
into N (Neutral) or depress the clutch on manual transmission
vehicles. Push the transfer case shift lever to the desired
position. If it is difficult to shift into either 4H or 4L, it may be
necessary to let the vehicle roll slightly and/or turn off the
engine (particularly on vehicles equipped with automatic
transmissions).
[GF19200(R)05/96]
Driving Off Road with 4-Wheel Drive
[GF19300(R)05/96]
Vehicles equipped with four-wheel drive are especially equipped
for driving on sand, snow, mud, or rough terrain and have
operating characteristics that are somewhat different from
conventional vehicles, both off and on the road. The driving tips
below will help you learn to use four-wheel drive.
[GF19500(R)01/96]
■ Do not use four-wheel drive on dry, hard-surfaced roads,
especially with a temporary spare tire in use.
*[GF19600(R)01/96]
■ Special maintenance procedures are necessary after operating
*[GF19700(R)01/96]
■ Manual locking hubs must be in LOCK position before
with drive components in water.
shifting into four-wheel drive.
183
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF19800(R)05/96]
When using four-wheel drive, maintain steering wheel control at
all times, especially in rough terrain. Since sudden changes in
terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel motion, make sure
you grip the steering wheel rim from the outside. Do not grip
the spokes.
*[GF19900(R)01/96]
Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed objects
such as rocks and stumps. Know the terrain or examine maps of
the area in question before driving. Map out your route
beforehand. To maintain steering and braking control of your
vehicle, you must have all four tires on the ground, and they
must be rolling, not sliding or spinning.
[GF19925(R)01/96]
Transmission upshift in 4WD with transfer case in 4WD LOW
may be quite firm due to large total gear reduction. This
condition is normal.
*[GF19930(R)05/96]
Rocking the Vehicle
[GF19940(R)05/96]
If your vehicle gets stuck, engage 4WD LOW (for 4x4-equipped
vehicles) and try to drive away.
[GF19950(R)05/96]
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, you may rock it out
of the spot. Shift in a steady rhythm between forward and
reverse gears. Allow the transmission to fully engage, then press
lightly on the accelerator. Do not rock the vehicle for more than
a few minutes. This may overheat the engine and transmission,
causing damage to both. In addition, other vehicle systems and
components may also be damaged.
*[GF19960(R)05/96]
WARNING
Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (55 km/h). The
tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.
184
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF20000(R)01/96]
*[GF20100(R)01/96]
Sand
*[GF20200(R)01/96]
*[GF20300(R)01/96]
Mud and Water
*[GF20400(R)01/96]
Once through water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not
stop the vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be
improved by moving your vehicle slowly, while applying light
pressure on the brake pedal.
*[GF20500(R)01/96]
After driving through mud, clean off residue stuck to rotating
driveshafts and tires. Excess mud stuck on tires and rotating
driveshafts causes an imbalance which could damage drive
components.
*[GF20525(R)03/96]
NOTE: If the transmission and transfer case is submerged in
water, their fluids should be checked and changed, if
necessary.
When driving over sand, try to keep all four wheels of the
vehicle on the most solid area of the trail. Do not reduce the
tire pressures but shift to a lower gear and drive steadily
through the terrain. Apply accelerator slowly and avoid
spinning the wheels.
When driving through water, determine the depth; avoid water
higher than the bottom of the hubs (if possible) and proceed
slowly. If the ignition system gets wet, the vehicle may stall.
185
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
%
*[GF20600(R)01/96]
Additional Special Driving Instructions for
4-Wheel Drive Vehicle Operators
*[GF20701(R)01/96]
Driving on Hill or Slope Terrain
[GF20800(R)03/96]
When driving on a hill, avoid driving crosswise or turning on
steep slopes; you could lose traction and slip sideways. Drive
straight up, straight down or avoid the hill completely. Know
the conditions on the other side of a hill before driving over the
crest.
*[GF20900(R)01/96]
When climbing a steep hill, start in a lower gear, rather than
finding it necessary to downshift from a higher gear after the
ascent has started. This reduces strain on the engine and the
possibility of stalling.
*[GF21000(R)01/96]
When descending a steep hill avoid sudden braking. Rapid
pumping of the brake pedal will help slow the vehicle and still
maintain steering control.
*[GF21101(R)01/96]
Driving on Snow or Ice
[GF21200(R)01/96]
A four-wheel drive or all-wheel drive vehicle has advantages
over two-wheel drive vehicles in snow and ice but can skid like
any other vehicle. If so equipped, keep the vehicle in four-wheel
drive if icy or slippery conditions exist.
*[GF21300(R)01/96]
Avoid sudden applications of power and quick changes of
direction on snow or ice. Apply the accelerator slowly and
steadily when starting from a full stop.
*[GF21310(R)01/96]
All utility-type and Four-Wheel Drive vehicles have special
design and equipment features to make them capable of
performing in a wide variety of off-road applications. Specific
design characteristics give them higher centers of gravity than
ordinary passenger cars.
186
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF21325(R)01/96]
WARNING
Utility and four-wheel drive vehicles are NOT designed
for cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any
more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp
turns or abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles.
*[GF28050(R)01/96]
*[GF28101(R)01/96]
Driving With a Heavy Load
*[GF28150(R)01/96]
The weight limits of your vehicle’s tires affect the GVWR or
GAWR limitations. Usage of replacement tires with higher
weight limits than originals does not increase GVWR or GAWR.
Usage of lower capacity replacement tires may lower GVWR
and GAWR limitations.
%
*[GF28201(R)01/96]
There are limits to the amount of weight your vehicle can carry
or tow. The total weight of your vehicle, plus the weight of the
passengers and cargo, should never be more than the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). Also, the weight that your
vehicle carries over the front axle and rear axle should never be
more than the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for the
respective axle.
WARNING
Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the
Safety Compliance Certification Label.
*[GF28350(R)05/96]
Securing Loads in Cargo Area
[GF28400(R)01/96]
To prevent damage to the pickup box and cab, secure any
movable cargo pieces using ropes or straps and the tie down
holes in the stake pockets of the steel pickup box or the tiedown brackets inside the pickup box.
[GF28425(R)06/96]
The Splash pickup box contains additional tie-down hooks to
secure cargo.
187
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF28450(R)01/96]
Secure all items in cargo area to prevent them from falling out
and creating a safety hazard on the roadway.
[GF28500(R)05/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090120-D
Cargo tie-down holes and brackets
[GF28575(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Cargo tie-down hooks — Splash pickup box
art:0020968-B
188
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF28600(R)01/96]
Loading sheets of building material
[GF28650(R)01/96]
Four-foot (122 cm) wide sheets of building or other material will
not fit flat on the pickup box floor. However, support pockets
in the pickup walls permit up to 500 lb (227 kg) of this type
cargo to be carried on crossbody mounted 2“ x 6” (5 x 15 cm)
boards (styleside box only). See illustration.
[GF28675(R)01/96]
NOTE: Four-foot wide sheets will not fit flat on the Splash
pickup box floor.
[GF28700(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090121-A
Loading four foot (122 cm) building material sheets (styleside box only)
189
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF28750(R)03/96]
*[GF28801(R)03/96]
Vehicle/Trailer Loads
*[GF28950(R)05/96]
*[GF29001(R)01/96]
Trailer Towing
*[GF29025(R)01/96]
Your trailer towing capability will vary based on the standard
and optional equipment on your vehicle. Refer to the following
Vehicle Loading/Towing Information and the Trailer Towing Tables
to determine the specific towing capability of your vehicle.
*[GF29050(R)01/96]
*[GF29101(R)05/96]
■ Stay within the load limits when you tow.
*[GF29151(R)05/96]
■ Use extra caution when driving your vehicle while you tow.
*[GF29201(R)05/96]
■ Service your vehicle more frequently if you tow a trailer.
*[GF29350(R)01/96]
Do not tow a trailer until your vehicle has been driven at least
500 miles (800 km).
All vehicles may tow a Class I trailer provided the Gross
Combined Weight (GCW) is less than or equal to the GVWR
shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. For heavier
trailer applications, refer to the towing information found later
in this chapter.
Towing a trailer puts additional loads on your vehicle’s engine,
transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. For your safety
and for the good of your vehicle, use the right equipment for
the type of trailer you tow.
■ Carefully and thoroughly prepare your vehicle for towing,
making sure to use the right equipment and to attach it
properly. (See Preparing to Tow in this chapter.)
(See Driving while you tow in this chapter.)
(See Servicing your vehicle if you tow in this chapter.)
190
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF29401(R)01/96]
*[GF29450(R)01/96]
Vehicle Loading/Towing Information
*[GF29501(R)01/96]
Trucks, unlike passenger cars, are basically custom vehicles
designed to carry a load. Most owners start with a base vehicle
and add production and dealer installed and/or aftermarket
components to suit their tastes and purposes. Even trucks that
are purchased for personal transportation only are likely to have
considerable optional equipment, such as step bumpers and
light bars, for example.
%
*[GF29525(R)05/96]
Your vehicle’s load capacity is designated by weight, not
volume, so you cannot necessarily use all available space with
large or heavy loads. Maximum safe vehicle weights as well as
tire, rim sizes and inflation pressures are specified for your
vehicle at the assembly plant on the Safety Compliance
Certification Label. The Certification Label is located on the left
front door lock facing or the door latch post pillar.
WARNING
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside
or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or
killed. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts.
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a
safety belt properly.
*[GF29551(R)01/96]
Each additional item of equipment affects how much cargo a
vehicle can carry. If a vehicle is overloaded, performance will
suffer and service concerns may arise.
191
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF29601(R)01/96]
The following is a typical example of a Safety Compliance
Certification Label and an explanation of how this information
should be used:
[GF29901(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020153-H
*[GF29950(R)01/96]
Safety Compliance Certification Label
Do not use the sample numbers on the Safety Compliance
Certification Label shown. Use the actual numbers from your
vehicle certification label.
192
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF30001(R)01/96]
*[GF30050(R)01/96]
Understanding Loading/Towing Information
*[GF30101(R)01/96]
*[GF30150(R)01/96]
*[GF30200(R)01/96]
*[GF30250(R)01/96]
*[GF30301(R)01/96]
*[GF30310(R)01/96]
*[GF30320(R)01/96]
*[GF30330(R)01/96]
*[GF30340(R)01/96]
*[GF30351(R)01/96]
*[GF30401(R)01/96]
■ Base Curb Weight
The following terms are used to describe the ability to carry or
tow a load:
■ Payload
■ GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
■ GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
■ GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
■ GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)
■ Maximum Trailer Weight Rating
■ Maximum Trailer Weight
■ Trailer Weight Range
Base Curb Weight
The Base Curb Weight is the weight of the vehicle including
fuel, coolants, lubricants, emergency tools, spare wheel and tire.
It also includes any equipment that is standard on that model. It
does not include passengers, cargo or optional equipment
installed by factory, dealer, aftermarket supplier or customer.
*[GF30451(R)01/96]
*[GF30501(R)01/96]
Payload
*[GF30550(R)01/96]
*[GF30601(R)01/96]
Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW)
Payload is the combined, maximum allowable weight of cargo,
occupants and optional equipment that the truck is designed to
carry. It is Gross Vehicle Weight Rating minus the base curb
weight.
If you add base curb weight and the weight of a load (including
passengers, cargo and optional equipment) being carried at a
particular time, you get the Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW).
193
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF30650(R)01/96]
It is important to remember that GVW is not a limit or a
specification. If an owner loads up a vehicle and weighs it, that’s
the GVW at that moment. If the owner piles on more of a load
and weighs it again, that becomes the GVW.
*[GF30701(R)01/96]
*[GF30750(R)01/96]
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
*[GF30801(R)01/96]
*[GF30850(R)01/96]
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
*[GF30901(R)01/96]
Your Safety Compliance Certification Label not only gives the
GVWR, it also gives the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
which is the carrying capacity for each axle system. For trucks,
the rear axle will be designed to carry more weight than the
front.
*[GF30950(R)01/96]
The rating is based on the carrying capacity of the lowest rated
axle and suspension component as well as other factors. This is
why it’s so important to observe vehicle loading ratings.
Overloading a vehicle punishes components and can lead to
shortened service life or outright failure.
*[GF31001(R)01/96]
The capacity of the tires is included as part of the axle and
suspension system, which is to be considered when determining
the lowest rated component. Tires are rated to carry a specific
maximum load at a specific maximum tire pressure.
%
%
To avoid overloading a vehicle, the owner should observe the
manufacturer’s specified Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. The
GVWR is the maximum total weight of base vehicle, passengers,
optional components and cargo that a particular vehicle was
designed to carry.
We have all seen a car or a truck that is loaded down in the
rear and riding high in the front. This is a dangerous condition
that usually means that the rear suspension components are
under severe strain and that vehicle handling is impaired. There
is more to carrying a load than just payload or GVWR.
194
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF31050(R)01/96]
Passenger car type tires when installed on light trucks and
multipurpose passenger vehicles are rated at 10% lower load
carrying capacity due to the differences in vehicle usages.
*[GF31101(R)01/96]
The vehicle must not be loaded to both the front and rear
GAWR because the GVWR will be exceeded. The GAWR of the
front and rear axles exceeds the GVWR when added together to
allow flexibility in fore and aft loading of cargo.
*[GF31110(R)03/96]
With the tires inflated to the specified pressure, the total weight
of your vehicle must not exceed the GVWR and GAWR
specified on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. This
includes full fuel tank(s), vehicle equipment, and occupants as
well as the cargo load.
*[GF31120(R)01/96]
*[GF31130(R)01/96]
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)
*[GF31140(R)01/96]
*[GF31150(R)01/96]
Maximum Trailer Weight Rating
*[GF31160(R)01/96]
*[GF31170(R)01/96]
Maximum Trailer Weight
GCWR is the maximum combined weight of the towing
vehicle (including passengers and cargo) and the loaded trailer.
The GCWR is specified by the manufacturer to indicate the
combined maximum loaded weight that the vehicle is designed
to tow.
The maximum trailer weight rating is the maximum weight of a
trailer the vehicle is permitted to tow. It is specified by the
manufacturer and is determined by subtracting the vehicle curb
weight for each engine/transmission combination, any required
option weight for trailer towing and the weight of the driver
from the GCWR for the towing vehicle.
The maximum trailer weight is the maximum weight of a trailer
the loaded vehicle is permitted to tow. It is determined by
subtracting the weight of the loaded towing vehicle (including
passengers and cargo) from the GCWR for the towing vehicle.
195
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF31180(R)01/96]
*[GF31190(R)01/96]
Trailer Weight Range
[GF31250(R)01/96]
NOTE: Ranger pick-ups are not recommended for slide-in
camper usage.
*[GF31301(R)01/96]
*[GF31350(R)01/96]
*[GF31401(R)03/96]
Calculating The Load
%
The trailer weight range is a specified range by weight, which
the trailer must fall within, ranging from zero to the maximum
trailer weight rating.
To know how much weight your vehicle can carry:
■ Obtain ratings from your Safety Compliance Certification
Label, and the Trailer towing specifications in the Owner
Guide (refer to the Index)
*[GF31450(R)01/96]
— Refer to the following sample illustration to locate the
various ratings on your Safety Compliance Certification
Label.
*[GF31501(R)01/96]
— If you do not plan on pulling a trailer, do not include
these ratings into your calculations.
*[GF31550(R)01/96]
■ Weigh your vehicle as you customarily operate the vehicle
*[GF31601(R)01/96]
■ Subtract the total weight of passengers, driver and optional
(without cargo).
equipment added by the factory, dealer or aftermarket
supplier to determine how much cargo weight you can carry.
196
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF31650(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0021184-A
*[GF31702(R)01/96]
Sample label
If you suspect that your payload is excessive, have your vehicle
weighed at a highway weigh station or appropriate commercial
facility. Weigh the total vehicle and trailer (if applicable), then
separately weigh the vehicle at the front and rear wheels. And
finally, weigh the trailer separately if applicable.
197
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF31751(R)01/96]
Use this chart to perform your calculations.
[GF31801(R)01/96]
twenty-six pica
chart:0090124-A
*[GF31851(R)01/96]
NOTE: The Truck Safety Compliance Certification Label has
two weight related entries that sometimes cause
confusion.
198
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF31901(R)01/96]
Front Axle Reserve Capacity in Pounds (kgs): If this value is
given as 83 pounds (38 kgs) on the label, does this mean that
you are limited to adding only 83 pounds (38 kgs) of
accessories to the front end capacity? Not exactly. This says that
you can load 83 pounds (38 kgs) of options on the front axle,
add 150 pound (68 kgs) passengers to all seating positions, and
add evenly distributed cargo in the box without exceeding the
GAWR F.
*[GF31950(R)01/96]
It is possible to hang heavier equipment on the front as long as
the vehicle owner/operator compensates. This can be
accomplished, if necessary, by carrying fewer passengers, less
cargo or positioning cargo more toward the rear, which has the
effect of reducing the load on the front. Keep in mind that the
GAWR F, GAWR R, nor the GVWR should ever be exceeded.
*[GF32001(R)01/96]
Total Accessory Reserve Capacity in Pounds (kgs): If, for
example, this value is given as 112 pounds (51 kgs), does this
mean that you are limited to adding 112 pounds (51 kgs) of
accessories to your vehicle? Not exactly. This is a number that is
related to government crash test standards, and only indirectly
reflects on the amount of accessory weight that can be carried.
*[GF32050(R)01/96]
In the case of both these numbers (83 and 112 pounds) (38 and
51 kgs), the important thing to remember is that for safe
operation, an owner/operator should calculate the amount and
the distribution of all weights (passengers, accessory equipment
and cargo). These combined weights should fall below the
vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR.
199
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF32101(R)01/96]
Camper Bodies
[GF32175(R)01/96]
NOTE: Your Ranger Pickup is not recommended for slide-in
camper bodies.
*[GF32201(R)01/96]
*[GF32251(R)01/96]
Trailers
*[GF32301(R)01/96]
If your vehicle exceeds the GVWR, remove cargo from your
vehicle accordingly. If your vehicle exceeds the GAWR for
either axle, shift the load or remove cargo accordingly.
Towing a trailer safely means having the proper weight on the
tongue (usually 10% of the trailer weight). Load-equalizing
hitches on large rigs may transfer weight to each of the vehicle’s
axles. This weight must be included in capacity calculations
when determining if the vehicle is loaded within safe limits.
*[GF32350(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the
Safety Compliance Certification Label.
*[GF32401(R)05/96]
WARNING
Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended
gross trailer weight could result in engine damage,
transmission/axle damage, structural damage, loss of
control, and personal injury.
*[GF32450(R)01/96]
Use the Safety Compliance Certification Label to find the axle
code number and the engine type for your vehicle.
*[GF32500(R)01/96]
Use the appropriate Maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating
(GCWR) chart to find the Maximum GCWR for your type
engine and rear axle ratio.
*[GF32551(R)01/96]
Subtract your Loaded Vehicle Weight from the Maximum
GCWR found in the chart. This is the maximum trailer weight
your vehicle can tow and must fall below the maximum shown
under Trailer Weight on the chart.
200
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF35200(R)01/96]
thirty-four pica
chart:0020174-G
201
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF35250(R)01/96]
ten pica chart:0020474-E
202
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF35280(R)01/96]
Manual Transmissions
[GF35300(R)01/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0020175-M
203
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF35325(R)01/96]
thirty-four pica
chart:0020961-G
204
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF35350(R)01/96]
thirty-four pica
chart:0020927-E
205
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF35360(R)01/96]
twenty pica
chart:0021259-A
206
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF35380(R)01/96]
Automatic Transmissions
[GF35400(R)01/96]
twenty-eight pica
chart:0020176-K
207
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF35425(R)01/96]
thirty-four pica
chart:0020970-G
208
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF35450(R)01/96]
twenty-six pica
chart:0020928-E
209
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
[GF35475(R)01/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0020971-E
210
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF36500(R)05/96]
*[GF36550(R)05/96]
Preparing to Tow
*[GF36600(R)01/96]
*[GF36650(R)01/96]
Hitches
*[GF36800(R)01/96]
Do not install a single or multi-clamp type bumper hitch, or a
hitch which attaches to the axle. Underbody mounted hitches
are acceptable if installed properly. Follow towing instructions
of a reputable rental agency.
*[GF37000(R)01/96]
Whenever a trailer hitch and hardware are removed, make sure
all mounting holes in the underbody are properly sealed to
prevent noxious gases or water from entering.
%
For your safety and for the good of your vehicle, use the right
equipment for the type of trailer you tow. Also, make sure that
all towing equipment is properly attached to your vehicle. If
you are not certain that you are using the right equipment in
the proper manner, see your Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.
For towing trailers up to 2,000 lb (907 kg), use a weight
carrying hitch and ball which uniformly distributes the trailer
tongue loads through the underbody structure. Use a
frame-mounted weight distributing hitch for trailers over 2,000
lb (907 kg).
211
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF37300(R)01/96]
Step bumper (If equipped)
[GF37400(R)01/96]
The optional step bumper has a built-in hitch and only requires
a ball with a 3/4 inch shank diameter. The step bumper has a
Class I capability (2,000 lb/907 kg trailer weight and 200
lb/91 kg tongue weight).
*[GF37550(R)05/96]
NOTE: The rated capacities (as shown in this guide) for
trailer towing with the factory bumper are only valid
when the trailer hitch ball is installed directly into the
ball hole in the bumper. Addition of bracketry to
either lower the hitch ball position or extend the hitch
ball rearward will significantly increase the loads on
the bumper and its attachments. This can result in the
failure of the bumper or the bumper attachments. Use
of any type of hitch extensions should be considered
abuse.
*[GF37575(R)05/96]
If it is necessary to relocate the trailer hitch ball position a
frame mounted trailer hitch must be installed.
*[GF37800(R)01/96]
*[GF37900(R)01/96]
Safety Chains
*[GF38000(R)01/96]
*[GF38100(R)01/96]
Trailer Brakes
%
%
Always use safety chains between your vehicle and trailer.
Cross chains under the trailer tongue and allow slack for
turning corners. Connect safety chains to the vehicle frame or
hook retainers. Never attach chains to the bumper.
Separate trailer brakes are required on most towed vehicles
weighing over 1,500 lb (680 kg).
*[GF38200(R)05/96]
WARNING
Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brake system directly
to your vehicle’s brake system. Your vehicle may not
have enough braking power and your chances of having
a collision greatly increase.
212
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
*[GF38300(R)01/96]
*[GF38400(R)01/96]
Trailer Lamps
*[GF38425(R)01/96]
Class I and Class II Trailer Tow electrical wiring provides two
circuits (right hand and left hand) to operate trailer stop/turn
tail lamps. Each stop/turn circuit will operate one combination
stop/turn light bulb (# 1157, 3157, 2357, or 3357) on the trailer.
Never add more than one trailer light bulb to one circuit.
%
*[GF38450(R)01/96]
Make sure your trailer lamps conform to Federal and local
regulations.
WARNING
Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified
amperage rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage
rating can cause severe wire damage and could start a
fire.
*[GF38500(R)01/96]
*[GF38520(R)05/96]
%
*[GF38540(R)05/96]
[GF38600(R)05/96]
Driving while you tow
Be especially careful when driving while you tow a trailer.
Never drive faster than 45 mph (70 km/h) when you tow in
hilly country on hot days. Also, anticipate stops so that you can
brake gradually.
If you use the speed control while you are towing on very long,
steep grades, the speed control may shut off.
When towing a trailer in hilly terrain, with a vehicle equipped
with a 4R44E/5R55E transmission, you may wish to operate in
O/D OFF rather than j (Overdrive). This will eliminate
excessive downshifting and upshifting to maintain speed. Shift
back to j (Overdrive) whenever practical for optimum
powertrain cooling and fuel economy. This can be accomplished
by pushing in the transmission control switch which is located
on the end of the gearshift lever.
213
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF38800(R)03/96]
When descending a steep grade with a trailer, operate in Drive
rather than Overdrive. If additional braking is needed, shift the
automatic transmission gearshift into the 2 (Second) or 1 (Low)
position.
[GF38925(R)05/96]
Servicing Your Vehicle If You Tow
*[GF38950(R)05/96]
If you tow a trailer for a long distance, your vehicle will need
to be serviced more frequently than usual. Refer to the
Maintenance Schedule booklet for additional information.
[GF39000(R)01/96]
Trailer towing tips
*[GF39100(R)01/96]
Before starting on a trip, practice turning, stopping and backing
in an area away from heavy traffic. Get to know the “feel” of
the vehicle/trailer combination.
*[GF39200(R)01/96]
Practice backing up. Back up very slowly, with someone outside
at the rear of your trailer to guide you. Place your hand at the
bottom of the steering wheel and move it in the direction you
want the rear of the trailer to swing. Slight movement of the
steering wheel results in a much larger movement of the rear of
the trailer.
*[GF39300(R)01/96]
Allow more room for stopping with a trailer attached. Trailer
brakes should be applied first, whether manually or
automatically controlled, when approaching a stop.
*[GF39400(R)01/96]
For a good handling truck-trailer combination, the trailer tongue
load should be approximately 10-15% of the loaded trailer
weight.
*[GF39500(R)01/96]
Make a thorough check of your equipment before starting out
on the road. After you have traveled about 50 miles (80 km)
stop in a protected area and double-check your hitch and
electrical connections. Also check trailer wheel lug nuts for
tightness.
*[GF39600(R)01/96]
When turning, drive slightly beyond the normal turning point
so the trailer wheels will clear curbs or other obstructions.
214
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
Driving
[GF39750(R)01/96]
When stopped in traffic for long periods of time in hot weather,
place the gearshift selector lever in P (Park) to increase the
engine idle speed. This aids in engine cooling and air
conditioner efficiency. If the engine overheats, rotate the
function selector control knob to panel position to stop the
compressor and increase the engine speed for a short time.
*[GF39800(R)05/96]
WARNING
Do not tow a trailer when using a temporary spare tire.
*[GF39900(R)01/96]
Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade.
However, if you must park on a grade, place wheel chocks
under the trailer’s wheels as follows:
*[GF40000(R)01/96]
*[GF40100(R)01/96]
■ Apply the brake pedal and hold.
*[GF40200(R)01/96]
■ With the chocks in place, release the brake pedal, making
*[GF40300(R)01/96]
■ For automatic transmissions — apply the parking brake by
[GF40400(R)01/96]
■ For manual transmissions — apply the service brake and
■ Have another person place the wheel chocks under the
trailer wheels.
sure the chocks are holding.
pressing the service brake pedal down firmly with your right
foot while applying the parking brake pedal with your left
foot.
shift into N (Neutral) while still maintaining pressure on the
service brake pedal. Set the parking brake fully.
*[GF40500(R)01/96]
■ Shift an automatic transmission into Park (P). Put the
gearshift of a manual transmission in Reverse. If your vehicle
is equipped with four-wheel drive make sure the transfer
case is not in Neutral.
215
File:09ungfr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:55:24 1997
*[GF40600(R)01/96]
*[GF40700(R)01/96]
*[GF40800(R)01/96]
*[GF40900(R)01/96]
*[GF41000(R)01/96]
To start, after being parked on a grade:
*[GF41100(R)01/96]
■ Apply the brake pedal and hold while another person
[GF41235(R)01/96]
Suspension Modifications
[GF41300(R)01/96]
The suspension and steering systems on your vehicle have been
designed and tested to provide both safe, predictable
performance (whether loaded or empty) as well as durable load
carrying capability. Any modifications to the suspension or
steering systems can reduce your vehicle’s performance
capability and adversely affect driver and passenger safety. Ford
recommends that you DO NOT make modifications such as
adding or removing parts (like lift kits, stabilizer bars or
snowplowing equipment) or by using replacement parts
non-equivalent to the original factory equipment.
%
*[GF41400(R)01/96]
■ Apply the brake pedal and hold.
■ Start the engine.
■ Shift transmission into gear and release the parking brake.
■ Release the brake pedal and move the vehicle uphill to free
the wheel chocks.
retrieves the chocks.
Snowplowing
[GF41500(R)04/96]
WARNING
Do not use this vehicle for snowplowing.
216
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER00200(R)03/96]
*[ER00210(R)01/96]
Hazard Flasher
*[ER00212(R)03/96]
The flashers will flash and the high-mount brakelamp will stay
on steadily (not flash) with the brake pedal depressed.
*[ER00214(R)01/96]
The flashers work whether your vehicle is running or not. The
flashers work for up to two hours when the battery is fully
charged and in good condition without draining the battery
excessively. If the flashers run for longer than two hours or if
the battery is not fully charged, the battery power can be
drained.
*[ER00216(R)01/96]
*[ER00218(R)01/96]
To use the hazard flasher:
%
*[ER00220(R)01/96]
*[ER00230(R)01/96]
The hazard flasher is used to alert other drivers to hazardous
situations.
1. Push in the flasher button; it will pop out and the lamps will
begin to flash.
2. To stop the flashers, push in the flasher button again.
NOTE: The flasher button will be sticking up slightly higher
when on than when off.
[ER00250(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
art:0020079-D
Hazard flasher
217
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER00300(R)01/96]
*[ER00400(R)05/96]
The Fuel Pump Shut-off Switch
*[ER00500(R)05/96]
For information on how to check and reset the fuel pump
shut-off switch, see Fuel pump shut-off switch in the Index.
%
*[ER00700(R)01/96]
If the engine cranks but does not start or if you have had a
collision, the fuel pump shut-off switch may have been
triggered. The shut-off switch is a device that stops the fuel
pump when your vehicle has been involved in a substantial jolt.
Fuses
[ER00800(R)01/96]
Fuses protect your vehicle’s electrical system from overloading.
If electrical parts in your vehicle are not working, the system
may have been overloaded and blown a fuse. Before you
replace or repair any electrical parts, check the appropriate
fuses.
[ER00900(R)01/96]
The following charts tell you which fuses protect each electrical
part of your vehicle. If a fuse blows, all the parts of your
vehicle that use that circuit will not work.
*[ER01000(R)01/96]
Once you have determined which fuses to check, follow the
procedures under Checking and replacing fuses later in this
chapter.
218
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER01100(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0021207-B
Fuse panel (located left side of instrument panel)
219
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER01200(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090210-B
Fuses and their location
220
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER01300(R)05/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0090137-C
221
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER01400(R)05/96]
twenty-eight pica
chart:0090138-E
222
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
% [ER01900(R)04/96]
Power distribution box
*[ER01950(R)01/96]
The high current fuses contained in the Power Distribution Box
protect your vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads;
these fuses provide the connection between the battery and your
vehicle’s electrical systems.
*[ER02000(R)03/96]
The high current fuses are coded as follows: 30 amp — light
green, 40 amp — orange, 50 amp — red, 60 amp — blue.
*[ER02100(R)01/96]
WARNING
Always disconnect the battery before servicing high
current fuses.
*[ER02200(R)01/96]
*[ER02300(R)01/96]
Ford recommends that high current fuses be replaced by a
qualified technician.
WARNING
Always replace the cover to the Power Distribution Box
before reconnecting the battery or refilling fluid
reservoirs.
*[ER02400(R)01/96]
*[ER02500(R)01/96]
A blown high current fuse may be replaced but will continue to
blow until the cause of the overload condition is corrected.
WARNING
Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified
amperage rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage
rating can cause severe wire damage and could start a
fire.
223
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER02550(R)05/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0090141-D
*[ER02700(R)01/96]
*[ER02720(R)01/96]
%
[ER02730(R)01/96]
Power distribution box
Checking and Replacing Fuses
If you need to check a fuse, follow these steps:
1. Find the fuse panel, which is located in the left end of the
instrument panel. The power distribution box (described
earlier in this section) is found in the engine compartment,
mounted on a bracket attached to the left fender apron.
[ER02740(R)01/96]
To access the fuse panel, remove the fuse panel cover by
inserting your finger in the divot and pulling on the cover.
The underside of the cover contains four spare fuses. A fuse
pulling tool is located in the lower right corner of the fuse
panel in case you need to replace a blown fuse.
*[ER02750(R)01/96]
The spare fuses for your vehicle are color coded as follows:
10 amp — red, 15 amp — light blue, 20 amp — natural, 30
amp — light green.
224
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER02760(R)01/96]
2. On the fuse panel cover, find the number of the fuse you
*[ER02770(R)01/96]
3. Check the fuse to see if it is blown. Look through the clear
want to check. The diagram on the cover tells you where to
locate the fuse on the panel.
side of the fuse to see if the metal wire inside is separated. If
it is, the fuse is blown and should be replaced.
[ER02800(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021196-A
The side view of a fuse
*[ER02850(R)01/96]
4. Replace the fuse with one that has the right amperage rating
(see previous chart).
*[ER02860(R)01/96]
WARNING
Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified
amperage rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage
rating can cause severe wire damage and could start a
fire.
*[ER02870(R)01/96]
*[ER02880(R)04/96]
%
*[ER02900(R)01/96]
[ER02950(R)03/96]
5. Put the fuse panel cover back on.
Even after you replace a fuse, it may continue to blow if you do
not find what caused the overload. If the fuse continues to
blow, have your electrical system checked.
Relays
Relays are devices which receive signals from components or
systems. After receiving signals, relays transfer these signals to
activate or deactivate other components or systems.
225
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER03000(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0021116-C
Relays and their locations on high-content vehicles
226
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER03500(R)06/96]
NOTE: Vehicles that are not equipped with the power group,
4WABS (4-Wheel Anti-lock Brakes System), or four
wheel drive have alternate locations for some relays.
The 4x4 shift relay module is located below the GEM
(Generic Electronic Module). The power window relay
or interior lamps relay is below the glove box. The
driver’s door unlock relay or battery saver relay is
above the RABS (Rear Anti-lock Brakes System)
module.
*[ER03600(R)02/96]
*[ER03700(R)02/96]
Changing a Tire
*[ER03800(R)01/96]
*[ER03900(R)02/96]
The Conventional Spare Tire
%
%
*[ER03930(R)05/96]
If you get a flat tire while you are driving, do not apply the
brake heavily. Instead, gradually decrease the speed. Hold the
steering wheel firmly and slowly move to a safe place on the
side of the road. Park on a level spot, turn off the ignition, set
the parking brake, and turn on the hazard flashers.
If you have the conventional spare tire, you can use it as a
spare or as a regular tire. This spare tire is identical to the other
tires that come with your vehicle, although the wheel may not
match.
WARNING
To avoid injury, never run the engine with one wheel off
the ground, such as when changing a tire.
*[ER04000(R)02/96]
% [ER04100(R)02/96]
*
%
The Temporary Spare Tire
You may have a high pressure temporary spare tire. This spare
tire is smaller than a regular tire and is designed for emergency
use only. Use it only when you get a flat tire and replace it as
soon as you can. This spare tire is marked with the words
“TEMPORARY USE ONLY” so that you can easily identify it.
227
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER04150(R)01/96]
It is not recommended that the vehicle be operated in the 4WD
modes with a temporary spare. If 4WD operation is necessary,
do not operate at speeds above 10 mph (16 km/h) or for
distances above 50 miles (80 km). Extended operation in 4WD
with a temporary spare may result in damage to powertrain
components.
*[ER04200(R)02/96]
WARNING
If you use the temporary spare tire continuously or do
not follow these precautions, the tire could fail, causing
you to lose control of the vehicle, possibly injuring
yourself or others.
*[ER04275(R)05/96]
WARNING
To avoid injury, never run the engine with one wheel off
the ground, such as when changing a tire.
*[ER04280(R)01/96]
Extended use of other than matching size spare tires on a
Traction-Lok axle could result in a permanent reduction in
effectiveness. This loss of effectiveness does not affect normal
driving and should not be noticeable to the driver.
*[ER04300(R)02/96]
*[ER04400(R)02/96]
*[ER04500(R)02/96]
When you drive with the temporary spare tire, DO NOT:
*[ER04600(R)02/96]
*[ER04700(R)02/96]
*[ER04800(R)02/96]
■ tow a trailer.
*[ER04900(R)02/96]
■ use the wheel for any other type of vehicle.
[ER04950(R)01/96]
■ exceed 50 mph (80 km/h) under any circumstances.
■ load your vehicle so that it is heavier than the maximum
vehicle load rating listed on the tire decal.
■ use tire chains on this tire.
■ try to repair the temporary spare tire or remove it from its
wheel.
■ engage four-wheel drive on dry, hard-surfaced roads.
228
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER05000(R)02/96]
%
*[ER05100(R)02/96]
[ER05250(R)04/96]
■ drive through an automatic car wash with this tire. Because
the temporary spare tire is smaller than a conventional tire,
it reduces the ground clearance. Your vehicle may get caught
in the rails and it could be damaged.
Spare Tire Location
The spare tire for your vehicle is stowed at the rear under the
frame.
[ER13850(R)01/96]
24 pica art:0020284-C
Spare tire stowage
229
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER13900(R)01/96]
[ER14000(R)01/96]
To remove the spare tire:
1. Use the hex portion of the lug nut wrench to remove the
bolt that fastens the hinge to the channel.
[ER14100(R)01/96]
2. Swing the hinge away and lower the channel.
[ER14200(R)01/96]
3. Unscrew the retaining bolt using the tapered end of the lug
nut wrench through the eye of the bolt.
[ER14300(R)01/96]
[ER14400(R)04/96]
[ER14500(R)01/96]
4. Slide the spare tire out.
To stow spare tire:
1. Position spare tire, valve stem down, so it is balanced on the
support.
[ER14600(R)01/96]
2. Replace and tighten retaining bolt using the tapered end of
the lug nut wrench through the eye of the bolt.
[ER14700(R)01/96]
3. Raise channel to hinge and line up the bolt hole.
[ER14800(R)01/96]
4. Install bolt and tighten with the wrench.
*[ER15100(R)01/96]
WARNING
Make sure the spare tire and jacking equipment are
stowed and secured in the proper storage location.
*[ER15200(R)03/96]
*[ER15250(R)01/96]
%
*[ER15300(R)01/96]
*[ER15335(R)01/96]
Preparing to Change the Tire
NOTE: To lift your vehicle by other than the front or rear
jacking points, be sure to use only hoist adapters with
a wide contact surface.
1. Make sure that your vehicle will not move or roll. If you
have an automatic transmission, put the gearshift in Park. If
you have a manual transmission, put the gearshift in
Reverse. Set the parking brake and block the wheel that is
diagonally opposite the tire that you are changing.
NOTE: Make sure the ignition is in the OFF position.
230
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER15350(R)01/96]
If you have a four-wheel drive vehicles with manual locking
hubs, put transfer case lever in 2H, 4H, or 4L.
*[ER15390(R)03/96]
When one of the back wheels is off the ground, the transmission
alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or slipping off
the jack, even if the vehicle is in P (Park) or 1 (First). To
prevent the vehicle from moving when you change a tire, be
sure the parking brake is set, then block the wheel (both
directions) that is diagonally opposite (other side and end of the
vehicle) to the tire that is being changed.
*[ER15400(R)03/96]
WARNING
If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else
could be seriously injured.
*[ER15440(R)05/96]
WARNING
Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer
case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the
vehicle.
*[ER15550(R)01/96]
2. Get out the spare tire and jack.
[ER16200(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica art:0020288-E
Jack handle location and installation
231
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER16500(R)01/96]
The jack and lug nut wrench are stowed behind the passenger’s
seat. The jack handle is stowed under the hood on the radiator
support.
[ER16600(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020291-B
Jack stowage
[ER16700(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020292-B
Jack stowage
[ER16800(R)01/96]
3. Insert the tapered end of the lug nut wrench behind wheel
covers or hubcaps and twist off.
[ER16830(R)01/96]
WARNING
Use only the lug nut wrench provided to remove wheel
ornaments. Not using the tapered end of the lug nut
wrench at the pry-off notches may result in damage to
the finish of the wheel and ornament.
232
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER16850(R)01/96]
WARNING
Use only the lug nut wrench provided to remove wheel
ornaments. Not using the tapered end of the lug nut
wrench at the pry-off notches may result in damage to
the finish of the wheel and ornament.
*[ER16900(R)01/96]
4. Loosen the wheel nuts by pulling up on the handle of the
[ER17100(R)04/96]
5. Insert the jack handle into the jack and use the handle to
lug nut wrench about one-half turn (counterclockwise). Do
not remove the wheel lug nuts until you raise the tire off the
ground.
slide the jack under the vehicle.
*[ER17175(R)05/96]
WARNING
To avoid injury, never run the engine with one wheel off
the ground, such as when changing a tire.
*[ER17225(R)01/96]
% [ER17300(R)01/96]
*
%
Removing and Replacing the Tire
1. Positioning the jack
[ER18150(R)01/96]
a. To raise a front wheel, place the jack directly under the
shock absorber so that it contacts the bottom of the shock.
[ER18201(R)03/96]
b. To raise a rear tire, place the jack under the rear axle
between the spring shackle bolts.
233
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER18301(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica art:0020297-E
Front axle jacking point
c. Turn the jack handle clockwise until the wheel is a
maximum of one inch off the ground.
[ER18401(R)01/96]
[ER18551(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Rear axle jacking point
art:0021187-B
[ER18650(R)01/96]
NOTE: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point.
234
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER21151(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
art:0021188-A
*[ER21200(R)01/96]
WARNING
To lessen the risk of personal injury, do not put any part
of your body under the vehicle while changing a tire. Do
not start the engine when your vehicle is on the jack.
The jack is only meant for changing the tire.
*[ER21400(R)01/96]
*[ER21500(R)01/96]
*[ER21700(R)01/96]
2. Remove the lug nuts with the lug nut wrench.
*[ER22200(R)03/96]
5. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle
3. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire.
4. Thread the lug nuts on the wheel studs with the beveled
face toward the wheel. Use the lug nut wrench to screw the
lug nut snug against the wheel but do not tighten.
counterclockwise.
235
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER22300(R)01/96]
6. Remove the jack and fully tighten the lug nuts in the order
shown in the following illustration.
[ER22400(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021189-A
Lug nut tightening sequence
*[ER23400(R)01/96]
WARNING
Never use wheels or lug nuts different than the original
equipment as this could damage the wheel or mounting
system. This damage could allow the wheels to come off
while the vehicle is being driven.
*[ER23500(R)01/96]
7. Replace any wheel covers, ornaments, or hub caps that your
[ER23600(R)01/96]
8. Put the tire, jack, and wrench away. (Make sure jack is
vehicle has. Make sure that they are screwed or snapped into
place.
securely fastened so it does not rattle when you drive.)
*[ER23700(R)03/96]
[ER23750(R)03/96]
9. Unblock the wheels.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with P265 75R15 AT tires
or P235 75R15 AT tires do not stow a flat or inflated
full size tire in the spare tire carrier. The carrier is
designed to hold the temporary spare which comes
with your vehicle. The stowage of a full size tire in
the spare tire carrier may damage the tire or the
vehicle. The flat full size tire should be stowed and
tied down in the pickup box bed until it can be
repaired.
236
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER23800(R)03/96]
Retighten the wheel lug nuts to the specified torque at 500 miles
(800 km) of new vehicle operation and at intervals specified in
the Maintenance Schedule booklet.
*[ER24200(R)01/96]
Also retighten to the specified torque at 500 miles (800 km) of
operation after any wheel change or any time the lug nuts are
loosened.
*[ER24301(R)01/96]
WARNING
Failure to retighten wheel lug nuts at mileages specified
could allow wheels to come off while the vehicle is in
motion.
[ER24360(R)01/96]
eight pica
chart:0020316-B
*[ER24400(R)02/96]
*[ER24410(R)02/96]
%
*[ER24500(R)02/96]
Jump-Starting Your Vehicle
Your vehicle’s battery may die if you leave the lights on or any
electrical equipment on after you turn the engine off. If this
happens, you may be able to jump-start your vehicle with a
booster battery.
WARNING
The gases around the battery can explode if exposed to
flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could result
in injury or vehicle damage.
237
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER24600(R)02/96]
WARNING
To protect yourself when charging a battery, always
shield your face and eyes. Make sure that you can
breathe fresh air.
%
*[ER24700(R)02/96]
WARNING
Applying too much pressure on the ends when lifting a
battery could cause acid to spill. Lift the battery with a
carrier or with your hands on the opposite corners.
%
*[ER24800(R)05/96]
WARNING
Batteries contain sulfuric acid which burns skin, eyes,
and clothing.
*[ER24900(R)02/96]
If the acid touches someone’s skin, eyes, or clothing,
immediately flush the area with water for at least 15 minutes. If
someone swallows the acid, have him or her drink lots of milk
or water first, then Milk of Magnesia, a beaten egg, or vegetable
oil. Call a doctor immediately.
*[ER24950(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not push-start your vehicle. You could damage the
catalytic converter. For further information, see Jumper
Cables in the Index.
[ER25000(R)04/96]
WARNING
To avoid damage or injury, follow these directions in the
order they are given. If in doubt, call for road service.
238
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER25100(R)02/96]
*[ER25200(R)02/96]
%
Preparing Your Vehicle
1. Your vehicle has a 12-volt starting system, so you need to
use a 12-volt jumper system. You will damage your starting
motor, ignition system, and other electrical parts if you
connect them to a 24-volt power supply (either two 12-volt
batteries in series or a 24-volt generator set).
*[ER25300(R)02/96]
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle. You
*[ER25400(R)02/96]
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled
*[ER25500(R)02/96]
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive
*[ER25600(R)02/96]
5. Turn on the heater fan in both vehicles. Turning on the fan
*[ER25700(R)02/96]
*[ER25800(R)02/96]
%
could damage the vehicle’s electrical system.
vehicle. Make sure the vehicles do not touch each other. Set
the parking brake on both vehicles and stay clear of the
engine cooling fan and other moving parts.
corrosion before you attach the jumper cables.
helps protect the electrical system from voltage surges. Turn
off all other switches and lights in both vehicles to prevent
possible damage to either vehicle’s electrical systems.
Connecting the jumper cables
1. Connect one end of the first jumper cable to the positive (+)
terminal of the discharged battery. (You can connect either
jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal, as long as you use
the same cable for both positive terminals.) Most jumper
cables have a red cable and a black cable. The red cable is
generally used for the positive terminals and the black for
the negative ones.
*[ER25900(R)02/96]
2. Connect the other end of the first cable to the positive (+)
*[ER26000(R)02/96]
3. Connect one end of the second cable to the negative (s)
terminal of the booster battery.
terminal of the booster battery — NOT to the discharged
battery.
239
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER26100(R)01/96]
4. Connect the other end of that cable to a good metallic
surface on the engine or frame of the disabled vehicle. The
following illustration shows where you can find a metallic
surface.
*[ER26200(R)02/96]
WARNING
Do not connect the end of the second cable to the
negative (s) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A
spark may cause an explosion of the gases that surround
the battery.
[ER26300(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Attaching jumper cables
art:0021186-B
*[ER26500(R)02/96]
*[ER26600(R)02/96]
*[ER26700(R)02/96]
Jump-Starting
1. Make sure that the jumper cables are not in the way of
moving engine parts, then start the booster vehicle. Run the
engine at a moderate speed.
2. Let the discharged battery charge for a few minutes and then
start the disabled vehicle. It may take a couple of tries before
the vehicle starts. If the vehicle does not start after several
attempts, there may be a different problem.
240
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
*[ER26800(R)02/96]
*[ER26900(R)02/96]
*[ER26910(R)02/96]
%
*[ER26920(R)03/96]
*[ER26922(R)02/96]
*[ER26924(R)02/96]
3. When both vehicles are running, let them idle for a few
minutes to charge the discharged battery.
Removing jumper cables
1. Always remove the jumper cables in the reverse order.
Remove the negative (s) end of the jumper cable from the
metallic surface on the engine or frame of the disabled
vehicle.
2. Remove the negative (s) cable from the booster battery.
3. Remove the positive (+) cable from the booster battery.
4. Remove the other end of the positive (+) cable from the
discharged battery.
*[ER26926(R)02/96]
After the vehicle is started, let it idle for a while to let the
engine “relearn” its idle conditions. Drive it around for a while
with all electrical accessories turned off to let the battery
recharge. Driveability may be deteriorated slightly until all drive
modes are “relearned.” You may need to use a battery charger
to fully recharge the battery.
*[ER26928(R)03/96]
If you need to replace your battery, see Battery in the
Maintenance and Care chapter.
241
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
*[ER30000(R)04/96]
*[ER30100(R)01/96]
Towing Your Vehicle
[ER30300(R)01/96]
Ranger 4x2/4x4
[ER30500(R)04/96]
The recommended method to tow your Ranger is with flatbed
or wheel lift equipment. However, slingbelt towing is
acceptable.
[ER30700(R)01/96]
Ranger without rear bumper
[ER30900(R)01/96]
The recommended method to tow your Ranger is with flatbed
or wheel lift equipment. However, slingbelt towing is
acceptable. Be sure to remove the undervehicle spare tire before
attaching slingbelt towing equipment.
%
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional
towing service or, if you are a member, your roadside assistance
center.
242
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER31000(R)01/96]
three fourths page
art:0090196-A
*[ER31200(R)01/96]
When calling for a tow truck, tell the operator what kind of
vehicle you have. A towing manual is available from Ford
Motor Company for all authorized tow truck operators. Have
your tow truck driver refer to this manual for the proper
hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.
243
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER31800(R)01/96]
Recreational Towing — All wheels on the ground
[ER31900(R)01/96]
Towing your vehicle can be successfully performed by following
the appropriate guidelines for the type of powertrain on the
vehicle to be towed. The following guidelines, by powertrain
combination, are designed to ensure that the transmission is not
damaged due to insufficient lubrication.
[ER32000(R)01/96]
4 x 2 — Automatic transmission
*[ER32100(R)01/96]
■ Release the parking brake.
[ER32200(R)05/96]
■ Place transmission gearshift in N (Neutral).
[ER32300(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 35 mph (56 km/h).
[ER32400(R)01/96]
■ Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).
[ER32500(R)01/96]
If a distance of 50 miles (80 km) or speed of 35 mph (56 km/h)
will be exceeded, you must:
[ER32600(R)01/96]
■ Disconnect the driveshaft at the rear differential and properly
support it under the vehicle.
[ER32700(R)01/96]
■ Mark the driveshaft and axle flanges to ensure proper
position when reconnecting the driveshaft. Refer to service
manual for proper driveshaft fastener torque specification.
(See the Accessories chapter for information on ordering
service manuals.)
[ER32800(R)01/96]
WARNING
When disconnecting/installing the driveshaft, the parking
brake must be set and the wheels blocked to ensure the
vehicle does not roll.
[ER32900(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 55 mph (88 km/h), unlimited distance.
244
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER33000(R)01/96]
4 x 2 — Manual transmission
*[ER33100(R)01/96]
■ Release the parking brake.
[ER33200(R)01/96]
■ Place the transmission gearshift in the neutral position.
[ER33300(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is limited by towing equipment
manufacturer’s recommendation, unlimited distance.
[ER33400(R)01/96]
4 x 4 — Manual shift transfer case
*[ER33500(R)01/96]
■ Release the parking brake.
[ER33600(R)01/96]
■ Place the transmission gearshift in the neutral position.
[ER33700(R)01/96]
■ Place the transfer case gearshift in the neutral position.
[ER33800(R)01/96]
■ Set the manual locking hubs in the FREE position.
[ER33900(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 55 mph (88 km/h), unlimited distance.
[ER34000(R)01/96]
4 x 4 Electric shift transfer case
*[ER34200(R)01/96]
■ Release the parking brake.
[ER34300(R)01/96]
■ Place the transmission gearshift in the neutral position.
[ER34400(R)05/96]
■ Ensure the transfer case is in 2H and the auto hubs are
unlocked.
[ER34600(R)01/96]
NOTE: Both the 4WD and 4WD Low indicator lights in the
instrument panel will be off when the 4WD switch is
in 2WD.
[ER34700(R)01/96]
For automatic transmissions:
[ER34800(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 35 mph (56 km/h).
[ER34900(R)01/96]
■ Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).
245
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
[ER35000(R)01/96]
If a distance of 50 miles (80 km) or speed of 35 mph (56 km/h)
will be exceeded, you must:
[ER35100(R)01/96]
■ Remove the rear driveshaft.
[ER35300(R)01/96]
■ Mark the driveshaft and transfer case/axle flanges to ensure
proper position when installing the driveshaft. Refer to
service manual for proper driveshaft torque specification.
[ER35400(R)01/96]
WARNING
When disconnecting/installing the driveshaft, the parking
brake must be set and the wheels blocked to ensure the
vehicle does not roll.
[ER35500(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 55 mph (88 km/h), unlimited distance.
[ER35600(R)01/96]
For manual transmissions:
[ER35700(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 55 mph (88 km/h), unlimited distance.
[ER35800(R)01/96]
Limited vehicle operation, such as driving the vehicle while at a
campsite, can be accomplished with the rear driveshaft removed
by using the front drive to propel the vehicle. To operate the
vehicle in this condition, you must follow the following
guidelines:
[ER35900(R)01/96]
■ Place the transfer case in 4WD by rotating 4WD switch to
4WD HIGH.
[ER36000(R)01/96]
■ Drive the vehicle only on good surface roads to avoid
excessive loads on the front-wheel drive system.
[ER36100(R)01/96]
■ Maximum speed is 35 mph (56 km/h).
[ER36200(R)01/96]
■ Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).
[ER36300(R)01/96]
■ Avoid quick acceleration and steep grades.
246
File:10unerr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:56:46 1997
Roadside Emergencies
[ER36400(R)01/96]
To return the vehicle to a towable condition, you must:
[ER36500(R)01/96]
■ Place the transfer case in 2WD by rotating the 4WD switch
to 2WD.
[ER36600(R)01/96]
NOTE: Both the 4WD and 4WD Low indicator lights in the
instrument cluster will be off when the transfer case
is in 2WD.
[ER36700(R)01/96]
■ After 2WD is selected, the front hubs must be “unlocked” by
moving the vehicle in reverse direction for a minimum of ten
feet.
[ER36800(R)01/96]
■ Confirm the front hubs are unlocked by inspecting the front
drive shaft to verify it does not turn when the vehicle is
towed.
[ER36900(R)01/96]
In addition to the above guidelines, it is recommended that you
follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of the
towing apparatus.
247
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC00300(R)01/96]
*[MC00400(R)01/96]
*[MC00500(R)01/96]
%
*[MC00600(R)01/96]
Service Made Easy
Ford has two goals for servicing your vehicle.
1. When we can, we design parts that do not need to be
serviced.
2. We want to make servicing your vehicle as easy as possible.
To help you:
*[MC00700(R)01/96]
■ We highlight do-it-yourself items in yellow in the engine
*[MC00800(R)03/96]
■ When possible, we design parts that can be replaced without
*[MC00900(R)02/96]
■ We give you a Maintenance Schedule that makes tracking
*[MC01000(R)01/96]
This chapter tells you about the basic parts that you need to
check and service regularly.
*[MC01050(R)01/96]
If your vehicle needs professional servicing, your dealership can
provide the parts and service required. Check your Warranty
Information Booklet to find out which parts and services are
covered. Also see the Customer Assistance chapter of this Owner
Guide.
*[MC01300(R)02/96]
Ford Motor Company recommends that the Owner Maintenance
Checks listed in the Maintenance Schedule booklet be performed
for the proper operation of your vehicle. In addition to the
conditions listed in the Owner Maintenance Checklist, be alert for
any unusual noise, vibration, or other indication that your
vehicle may need service. If you do notice something unusual,
see that your vehicle is serviced promptly.
compartment so that you can find them easily.
tools.
routine service for your vehicle easy. The maintenance
schedule is located in the Maintenance Schedule booklet.
249
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
%
*[MC01400(R)05/96]
NOTE: Always dispose of used automotive fluids in a
responsible manner. Follow your community’s
standards for disposing of these types of fluids. Call
your local recycling center to find out about recycling
automotive fluids.
*[MC01600(R)01/96]
*[MC01700(R)01/96]
Precautions When Servicing Your Vehicle
*[MC01900(R)01/96]
■ If you must work with the engine running, avoid wearing
*[MC02000(R)01/96]
■ Do not work on a vehicle in an enclosed space with the
*[MC02100(R)01/96]
■ Never get under a vehicle while it is supported only by a
*[MC02200(R)01/96]
■ Keep all lit cigarettes and other smoking materials away
*[MC02500(R)01/96]
If you disconnect the battery, the engine must “relearn” its idle
conditions before your vehicle will drive properly. To find out
how the engine does this, see Battery in this chapter.
*[MC02600(R)01/96]
*[MC02660(R)01/96]
Working with the engine off:
%
Be especially careful when inspecting or servicing your vehicle.
Here are some general precautions for your safety:
loose clothing or jewelry that could get caught in moving
parts. Take appropriate precautions with long hair.
engine running, unless you are sure you have enough
ventilation.
jack. If you must work under a vehicle, use safety stands.
from the battery and all fuel-related parts.
1. Set the parking brake fully and make sure that the gearshift
is securely latched in P (Park).
*[MC02700(R)01/96]
2. Remove the key from the ignition after you turn the engine
*[MC02725(R)01/96]
3. Block the wheels. This will prevent your vehicle from
off.
moving unexpectedly.
250
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC02750(R)01/96]
[MC02775(R)01/96]
Working with the engine on:
1. Set the parking brake fully, and make sure the gearshift is
securely latched in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or
Neutral (manual transmission) and block the wheels.
*[MC02825(R)01/96]
2. Block the wheels. This will prevent your vehicle from
moving unexpectedly.
*[MC02900(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed
and do not remove it while the engine is running.
%
*[MC02950(R)02/96]
[MC03035(R)01/96]
Opening the Hood
1. Pull the hood release handle, located below the steering
column.
[MC03040(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020332-B
Hood release handle
[MC03075(R)01/96]
2. While applying upward pressure on the hood, lift the hood
latch handle located in the opening between the hood and
upper portion of the grille near the center, to your left, as
you face the front of the vehicle.
*[MC03100(R)01/96]
3. Disconnect the hood support from the retaining clip on the
radiator support and place it into the slot marked PROP in
the underside of the hood.
251
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC03700(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0020338-G
Hood and support
*[MC03775(R)01/96]
NOTE: Read and understand Precautions When Servicing Your
Vehicle at the beginning of this chapter before
opening the hood.
*[MC03800(R)01/96]
To close the hood, raise it so that the support rod comes away
from the slotted hole in the hood. Place the support rod in its
retaining clip and close the hood with enough force to make it
latch. Be sure to oil the hood latch every six months to maintain
smooth operation.
*[MC03900(R)01/96]
Always attempt to lift the hood after closing to be sure it is
securely latched.
252
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC04500(R)03/96]
*[MC04600(R)03/96]
Engine Compartment
[MC05400(R)01/96]
■ A 2.3 Liter EFI, I-4 twin plug engine, or
*[MC05455(R)03/96]
*[MC05460(R)03/96]
*[MC05500(R)03/96]
■ A 3.0 Liter SEFI, V-6 engine or
%
Your vehicle has one of the following types of engines:
■ A 4.0 Liter SEFI, V-6 engine.
The following pages show diagrams of each engine type and
where to find items that you should regularly service.
253
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC05590(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0020436-N
2.3L engine compartment service points
254
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC05615(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090152-B
Maintenance and Care
3.0L engine compartment service points
255
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC05625(R)05/96]
33-1/2 pica
art:0090153-B
4.0L engine compartment service points
256
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC13600(R)01/96]
*[MC13610(R)01/96]
%
Engine Oil Recommendations
We recommend using Motorcraft oil or an equivalent oil
meeting Ford Specification WSS-M2C153-F and displaying the
American Petroleum Institute CERTIFICATION MARK on the
front of the container.
*[MC13650(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
The API Certification Mark
art:0001314-A
*[MC13670(R)01/96]
*[MC13680(R)01/96]
*[MC13690(R)02/96]
% [MC13700(R)01/96]
*
Never use:
■ “Non-Detergent” oils
■ Oils labeled API SA, SB, SC, SD, SE, SF or SG
■ Additional engine oil additives, oil treatments or engine
treatments
%
*[MC13710(R)03/96]
Engine oils with an SAE 5W-30 viscosity are PREFERRED for
your vehicle. They provide the best engine performance, fuel
economy and engine protection for all climates down to -15˚F
(-25˚C).
%
*[MC13725(R)03/96]
Synthetic engine oils which are CERTIFIED and of the preferred
viscosity may be used in your engine. The engine oil and oil
filter must still be changed according to the maintenance
schedule.
257
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC13730(R)05/96]
NOTE: Ford production and aftermarket (Motorcraft) oil
filters are designed for added engine protection and
long life. If a replacement oil filter is used that does
not meet Ford material and design specifications,
startup engine noises or knock may be experienced. It
is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraft
oil filter (or another brand meeting Ford
specifications) for your engine application.
*[MC13775(R)01/96]
*[MC13800(R)01/96]
Checking and Adding Engine Oil
*[MC13900(R)01/96]
*[MC14000(R)01/96]
Checking the engine oil level:
%
%
[MC14050(R)04/96]
Since the proper amount of engine oil is important for safe
engine operation, check the oil using the dipstick each time you
put fuel in your vehicle. Remember the engine must be off, the
oil must be warm and the vehicle must be parked on level
ground.
1. Turn the engine off after it has warmed up and allow a few
minutes for the engine oil to drain back into the oil pan.
2. Set the parking brake, making sure the gearshift is securely
latched in P (Park) or 1 (manual transmission).
*[MC14100(R)01/96]
*[MC14200(R)01/96]
3. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.
*[MC14300(R)01/96]
5. Wipe the dipstick clean and put it back into position, making
4. Locate the engine oil dipstick (highlighted in yellow) and
carefully pull it out of the engine.
sure it is fully seated.
258
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC14400(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021256-C
Engine oil dipstick
[MC14500(R)01/96]
6. Carefully, pull the dipstick out again. If the oil level is below
the “ADD” line, add engine oil as necessary. If the oil level
is beyond the letter “F” in Full, engine damage or high oil
consumption may occur and some oil must be removed from
the engine.
*[MC14600(R)01/96]
*[MC14800(R)01/96]
*[MC15000(R)01/96]
7. Put the dipstick back in and make sure it is fully seated.
It may be necessary to add some oil between oil changes. Make
sure you use a CERTIFIED engine oil of the preferred viscosity.
Your vehicle’s warranty coverage may not apply if engine
damage is caused by the use of improper engine oil.
Add engine oil through the oil filler cap highlighted in yellow.
To add oil, remove the filler cap and use a funnel to pour oil
into the opening. Be careful not to overfill the engine. Recheck
the oil level after you finish adding oil.
259
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
%
*[MC16300(R)01/96]
[MC16350(R)01/96]
Changing the Engine Oil and the Oil Filter
Change the engine oil and oil filter per the following, whichever
occurs first:
[MC16375(R)01/96]
half page art:0090154-A
*[MC16400(R)02/96]
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule booklet for additional
information.
*[MC17150(R)03/96]
NOTE: See Refill Capacities, Motorcraft Parts and Lubrication
Specifications in the Capacities and Specifications chapter
for the appropriate oil filter and engine oil refill
quantity.
260
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
%
*[MC17250(R)05/96]
NOTE: Always dispose of used automotive fluids in a
responsible manner. Follow your community’s
standards for disposing of these types of fluids. Call
your local recycling center to find out about recycling
automotive fluids.
*[MC17275(R)01/96]
WARNING
Continuous contact with USED motor oil has caused
cancer in laboratory mice.
*[MC17285(R)01/96]
% [MC17300(R)05/96]
*
*[MC17310(R)01/96]
Protect your skin by washing with soap and water.
Brake Fluid
Your vehicle is equipped with a brake fluid level indicator in
the master cylinder which lights the BRAKE warning light on
the instrument panel when the brake fluid level is low.
*[MC17312(R)01/96]
Under normal circumstances, your vehicle should not use up
brake fluid rapidly. However, expect the level of the brake fluid
to slowly fall as you put more mileage on your vehicle and the
brake pads wear.
*[MC17314(R)01/96]
Check the brake fluid at least once a year. You can do this by
looking at the fluid level in the plastic brake fluid reservoir on
the master cylinder. The fluid level should be at or near the
MAX mark.
[MC17315(R)05/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0020382-C
Brake master cylinder
261
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC17316(R)01/96]
WARNING
Brake fluid is toxic.
*[MC17318(R)01/96]
If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for
15 minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken
internally, drink water and induce vomiting. Get medical
attention immediately.
*[MC17320(R)04/96]
If the fluid is low, carefully clean and remove the cap from the
reservoir. Fill the reservoir to the MAX line with Ford High
Performance DOT 3 Brake Fluid C6AZ-19542-AB, or equivalent
DOT 3 fluid meeting Ford specification ESA-M6C25-A.
*[MC17330(R)01/96]
NOTE: If brake fluid is spilled on painted surfaces, it must
be flushed and wiped away immediately. Brake fluid
may dissolve the paint finish on your vehicle.
*[MC17340(R)01/96]
WARNING
If you use a brake fluid that is not DOT 3, you will
cause permanent damage to your brakes.
*[MC17350(R)01/96]
*[MC17352(R)01/96]
Do not fill the reservoir above the MAX line.
If you find that the fluid level is excessively low — below the
seam or ridge on the outside of the plastic reservoir — have the
brake system inspected.
*[MC17360(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not let the reservoir for the master cylinder run dry.
This may cause the brakes to fail.
262
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC17400(R)05/96]
Clutch Fluid (If equipped)
*[MC17405(R)01/96]
During normal operation the fluid level in the clutch reservoir
will slowly rise. If for any reason the fluid level drops, maintain
the fluid level at the step in the reservoir body.
%
*[MC17410(R)05/96]
*[MC17415(R)05/96]
If it becomes necessary to remove the reservoir cap, thoroughly
clean the reservoir cap before removing it to prevent dirt or
water from entering the reservoir. Remove the internal
diaphragm and then add only a DOT 3 brake fluid such as Ford
High Performance DOT 3 Brake Fluid (Ford Part Number
C6AZ-19542-AB) Ford specification ESA-M6C25-A.
The clutch on your vehicle is automatically self-adjusting and
should not require any routine service.
[MC17420(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica art:0020376-E
Clutch fluid reservoir
*[MC17500(R)02/96]
*[MC17510(R)01/96]
%
Windshield Washer Fluid
Check the level of the windshield washer fluid every time you
stop for fuel. The reservoir for washer fluid is located on the
passenger’s side of the engine compartment. Visual inspection
can determine if the washer fluid is adequate. Do not operate
the washer when the reservoir is empty.
263
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC17550(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not put windshield washer fluid in the container for
the engine coolant.
[MC17600(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Adding windshield washer fluid
art:0090119-B
%
*[MC17650(R)02/96]
*[MC17652(R)01/96]
Use specially formulated windshield washer fluid rather than
plain water, because specially formulated washer fluids contain
additives that dissolve road grime. For safety reasons, washer
fluids containing an appropriate antifreeze such as methanol
should be used in freezing weather (temperatures below 32˚F
[0˚C]). State or local regulations on Volatile Organic Compounds
(VOCs) may restrict use of the most common antifreeze,
methanol. Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze
agents should be used only if they provide cold weather
protection without damaging the vehicle’s paint finish, wiper
blades, and windshield washer system.
If you choose to use a windshield washing solution that must
be mixed, follow the manufacturer’s mixing instructions.
Improperly mixed solutions may freeze unexpectedly.
264
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC17670(R)01/96]
WARNING
Windshield washer fluid contains methanol and it is
poisonous. Follow all instructions on the bottle of washer
fluid.
*[MC17800(R)01/96]
*[MC18000(R)01/96]
*[MC20075(R)05/96]
%
Engine Coolant
Adding engine coolant
WARNING
Do not put engine coolant in the container for the
windshield washer fluid.
[MC20080(R)05/96]
10-1/2 pica
Adding engine coolant
art:0090119-B
*[MC20100(R)05/96]
When the engine is cool, add a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant
and water to the engine coolant recovery reservoir — DO NOT
ADD DIRECTLY TO THE RADIATOR. Add straight water only
in an emergency, but you should replace it with a 50/50
mixture of coolant and distilled water as soon as possible.
265
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC20125(R)05/96]
Check the coolant level in the coolant recovery reservoir the
next few times you drive the vehicle. If necessary, add enough
of a 50/50 mixture of coolant and water to bring the liquid
level to the fill line on the reservoir.
*[MC20150(R)05/96]
WARNING
Never remove the coolant recovery cap while the engine
is running or hot.
*[MC20175(R)05/96]
If you must remove the coolant recovery cap, follow these steps
to avoid personal injury caused by escaping steam or engine
coolant:
*[MC20200(R)05/96]
1. Before you remove the cap, turn the engine off and let it
*[MC20225(R)05/96]
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the cap
*[MC20250(R)05/96]
*[MC20275(R)05/96]
3. Step back while the pressure releases.
cool.
and turn it slowly, counterclockwise to the first stop.
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released,
use the cloth to press the cap down, turn it counterclockwise,
and remove it.
*[MC20295(R)05/96]
Use Ford Premium Cooling System Fluid E2FZ-19549-AA (in
Canada, Motorcraft CXC-8-B) or an equivalent premium engine
coolant that meets Ford specification ESE-M97B44-A. Ford
Premium Engine Coolant is an optimized formula that will
protect all metals and rubber elastomers used in Ford cooling
systems for 4 years or 50,000 miles (80,000 km).
*[MC20300(R)05/96]
Do not use alcohol or methanol antifreeze or any engine
coolants mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze. Do not use
supplemental coolant additives in your vehicle. These additives
may harm your engine cooling system. The use of an improper
coolant may void the warranty of your vehicle’s engine cooling
system.
266
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC20325(R)05/96]
*[MC20350(R)05/96]
Recycled engine coolant
*[MC20375(R)05/96]
Always dispose of used automotive fluids in a responsible
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for
recycling and disposing of automotive fluids.
*[MC20400(R)05/96]
*[MC20425(R)05/96]
Coolant refill capacity
*[MC20450(R)05/96]
Have your dealer check the engine cooling system for leaks if
you have to add more than a quart (liter) of engine coolant per
month.
*[MC20475(R)05/96]
*[MC20490(R)05/96]
Severe winter climate
*[MC20500(R)01/96]
*[MC20600(R)01/96]
Checking Hoses
%
Ford Motor Company recommends that Ford and
Lincoln-Mercury dealers use recycled engine coolant produced
by Ford-approved processes. Not all coolant recycling processes
produce coolant which meets Ford specification ESE-M97B44-A,
and use of such coolant may harm engine and cooling system
components.
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can
hold, refer to the Capacities and Specifications chapter.
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than -34˚F [-36˚C]),
it may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration above
50%. Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the
coolant concentration in your vehicle is such that the coolant
will not freeze at the temperature level in which you drive
during winter months. Never increase the engine coolant
concentration above 60%. Leave a 50/50 mixture of engine
coolant and water in your vehicle year-round in non-extreme
climates.
Inspect all engine and heater system hoses for deterioration,
leaks and loose clamps before adding or replacing engine
coolant. Make whatever repairs or replacements that are
necessary using Motorcraft parts or their equivalents.
267
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC22800(R)01/96]
*[MC22810(R)01/96]
Power Steering Fluid
*[MC22900(R)01/96]
*[MC22910(R)04/96]
Checking and Adding Power Steering Fluid
%
%
Check the level of the power steering fluid at least twice a
year (i.e., every Spring and Fall).
1. Start the engine and let it run until the power steering fluid
reaches normal operating temperature. The power steering
fluid will be at the right temperature when the engine
coolant temperature gauge in the instrument cluster is near
the center of the normal operating temperature range.
*[MC22912(R)01/96]
2. While the engine idles, turn the steering wheel back and
*[MC22914(R)01/96]
% [MC22916(R)01/96]
*
3. Turn the engine off.
forth several times. Make sure that the cap assembly is
installed at this time.
4. Check the fluid level on the dipstick (which is highlighted in
yellow in your vehicle). The fluid level should be between
the arrows in the FULL HOT range, which is marked on the
side of the dipstick, opposite the side marked FULL COLD.
Do not add fluid if the level is within the FULL HOT range.
[MC22918(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Power steering dipstick
art:0021195-A
268
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC22930(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica art:0020384-E
Power steering reservoir
[MC22934(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Power steering reservoir
art:0020383-C
269
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC22936(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Power steering dipstick location
art:0090155-A
*[MC22940(R)01/96]
5. If the power steering fluid is low, add fluid in small
*[MC22942(R)03/96]
6. When you are finished, put the dipstick back in and make
amounts, continuously checking the level, until you reach the
FULL HOT range. Do not overfill.
sure that it fits snugly.
[MC22944(R)05/96]
Use only power steering fluid that meets Ford specification such
as MERCONH Multi-Purpose ATF XT-2-QDX (or equivalent).
*[MC22946(R)01/96]
If the power steering fluid is low, do not drive your vehicle for
a long period of time before adding fluid. This can damage the
power steering pump.
*[MC22948(R)03/96]
If you check the power steering fluid when it is cold, make sure
that the fluid reaches the FULL COLD range on the dipstick.
The reading will only be accurate if the fluid temperature is
approximately 50 to 85˚F (10 to 30˚C).
*[MC22950(R)01/96]
NOTE: Do not turn the steering wheel of your vehicle with
the engine off. It could force power steering fluid out
from the reservoir cap or in extreme cases, it could
unseat the cap.
270
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC22980(R)01/96]
*[MC22982(R)03/96]
Driveline Universal Joint and Slip Yoke
*[MC22986(R)05/96]
Your vehicle may be equipped with a constant velocity or
double cardan joint at the transfer case end of the driveshaft.
The front driveshaft double cardan joint may be fitted with a
flush type grease fitting that requires an adapter to permit
proper lubrication. Lubricate the drive joint according to the
intervals shown in the Maintenance Schedule booklet.
%
The universal joints that come standard with your vehicle do
not require lubrication. If your original equipment universal
joints are replaced with universal joints equipped with grease
fittings, lubrication will be necessary at the intervals shown in
the Maintenance Schedule booklet.
[MC22990(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021194-A
Double cardan joint
%
*[MC23000(R)01/96]
[MC23010(R)05/96]
Automatic Transmission Fluid
Under normal driving conditions your automatic transmission
does not use up transmission fluid. However, it is recommended
that you check the transmission fluid at least twice a year.
Vehicles under severe driving conditions must have the fluid
changed every 50,000 miles. If the transmission is not working
properly, for example, the transmission may slip or shift slowly,
or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage, the fluid level
should be checked.
271
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC23012(R)01/96]
It is preferable to check the transmission fluid level at normal
operating temperature, after approximately 20 miles (30 km) of
driving. However, if necessary, you can check the fluid level
without having to drive 20 miles to obtain a normal operating
temperature if outside temperatures are above 50˚F (10˚C).
*[MC23020(R)01/96]
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended
period at high speeds or in city traffic during hot
weather, or pulling a trailer, the vehicle should be
turned off for about 30 minutes to allow the fluid to
cool before checking.
*[MC23030(R)01/96]
*[MC23032(R)05/96]
Checking the Automatic Transmission Fluid
[MC23034(R)01/96]
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the 4x4 option must have the
4x4 shift selector in any position other than neutral. If
in neutral the vehicle may move.
%
With the vehicle on a level surface, start the engine and move
the gearshift lever through all of the gear ranges allowing
sufficient time for each position to engage. Securely latch the
gearshift lever in the P (Park) position, fully set the parking
brake and leave the engine running.
*[MC23040(R)01/96]
WARNING
Your vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is
below the bottom hole on the dipstick and outside
temperatures are above 50˚F (10˚C).
*[MC23045(R)01/96]
Wipe off the dipstick cap (located on the passenger’s side of the
engine), pull the dipstick out and wipe the indicator end clean.
Put the dipstick back into the filler tube and make sure it is
fully seated. Pull the dipstick out and read the fluid level.
*[MC23047(R)01/96]
When checking fluid at normal operating temperature, the fluid
level should be within the crosshatched area on the dipstick.
When the vehicle has not been driven, and outside temperature
is above 50˚F (10˚C), the fluid level should be between the holes
on the dipstick.
272
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC23050(R)01/96]
*[MC23053(R)01/96]
Adding Automatic Transmission Fluid
*[MC23055(R)01/96]
Add fluid in 1/2 pint (.25L) increments through the filler tube
to bring the level to the correct area on the dipstick. If an
overfill occurs, excess fluid should be removed by a qualified
technician.
%
%
*[MC23057(R)05/96]
The fluid type is stamped on the dipstick. Before adding any
fluid, be sure that the correct type will be used.
NOTE: Always dispose of used automotive fluids in a
responsible manner. Follow your community’s
standards for disposing of these types of fluids. Call
your local recycling center to find out about recycling
automotive fluids.
[MC23060(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0021193-A
Automatic transmission dipstick
273
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
%
*[MC23100(R)01/96]
Manual Transmission and Transfer Case
Fluid
[MC23110(R)04/96]
Checking the Manual Transmission Fluid
*[MC23112(R)01/96]
Clean the filler plug on the side of the case. Remove the filler
plug. The fluid level should be up to the bottom of the filler
plug hole.
*[MC23114(R)01/96]
If additional fluid is required:
[MC23116(R)04/96]
1. Add enough fluid through the filler plug hole to bring the
level up to the bottom of the hole. Use only fluid certified to
meet Ford Motor Company lubricant specification as listed
under Refill Capacities, Motorcraft Parts, and Lubricant
Specifications, later in this chapter.
*[MC23118(R)01/96]
2. Replace the filler plug in its original position, making sure it
is fully seated.
*[MC23300(R)01/96]
*[MC23310(R)01/96]
Battery
*[MC23312(R)01/96]
If you see any corrosion on the battery cables or terminals,
remove the cables from the terminal and clean them both with a
wire brush. You can neutralize the acid with a solution of
baking soda and water. Reinstall the cables when you are done
cleaning them, and apply a small quantity of grease to the top
of each battery terminal to help prevent corrosion.
%
Your vehicle may have a Motorcraft maintenance-free battery.
The Motorcraft maintenance-free battery does not require
additional water during its life of service. The vents are part of
the cover and cannot be removed. For longer, trouble-free
operation, keep the top of the battery clean and dry. Also, make
certain the battery cables are tightly fastened to the battery
terminals.
274
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC23330(R)01/96]
*[MC23332(R)01/96]
Battery replacement
[MC23334(R)01/96]
NOTE: If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is
re-installed after the battery is replaced.
*[MC23336(R)01/96]
Check your battery’s electrolyte level, at least every 12 months
or 12,000 miles (20,000 km), in temperatures up to 90˚F (32˚C)
and more often in temperatures above 90˚F (32˚C). Keep the
electrolyte in each cell up to the “level” indicator. Do not
overfill the battery cell.
*[MC23338(R)01/96]
If the electrolyte level in your battery gets low, you can add
plain tap water to the battery, as long as you don’t use hard
water, or water with a high mineral or alkali content. If
possible, however, try to only fill the battery cell with distilled
water. If the battery needs water often, have the charging
system checked.
*[MC23340(R)01/96]
*[MC23345(R)01/96]
Help Us Protect Our Environment
%
If your original equipment battery requires replacement (under
warranty), it may in some cases be replaced by a Motorcraft
low-maintenance battery. The low-maintenance battery has
removable vent caps for checking the electrolyte level and for
adding water, if needed.
Ford Motor Company strongly recommends that used lead-acid
batteries be returned to an authorized recycling facility for
disposal.
*[MC23350(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0040201-A
Battery recycling symbol
275
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
%
*[MC23400(R)05/96]
*[MC23410(R)01/96]
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically controlled by a
computer, some control conditions are maintained by power
from the battery. If you ever disconnect the battery, install a
new battery, or experience a dead battery, you must allow the
computer to “relearn” its idle conditions before your vehicle will
idle at its best. To let the engine do this, apply the parking
brake, put the gearshift in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or
Neutral (manual transmission), turn off all the accessories, and
start the vehicle. Let the engine idle for at least one minute.
If you do not let the engine relearn its idle, the idle quality of
your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle is
relearned. Your vehicle will eventually relearn its idle while you
drive it, but it takes much longer than if you use the previous
procedure.
*[MC23450(R)01/96]
WARNING
Batteries normally produce explosive gases which can
cause personal injury. Do not allow flames, sparks or lit
tobacco to come near the battery. Always cover your face
and protect your eyes and also provide ventilation.
%
*[MC23460(R)05/96]
WARNING
Batteries contain sulfuric acid which burns skin, eyes,
and clothing.
*[MC23470(R)02/96]
If the acid touches someone’s skin, eyes, or clothing,
immediately flush the area with water for at least 15 minutes. If
someone swallows the acid, have him or her drink lots of milk
or water first, then Milk of Magnesia, a beaten egg, or vegetable
oil. Call a doctor immediately.
276
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
%
*[MC23480(R)02/96]
WARNING
Applying too much pressure on the ends when lifting a
battery could cause acid to spill. Lift the battery with a
carrier or with your hands on the opposite corners.
*[MC24500(R)02/96]
*[MC24600(R)01/96]
Wiper Blades
*[MC24700(R)01/96]
If the blades do not wipe properly, clean both the windshield
and the wiper blades. Use undiluted windshield washer solution
or a mild detergent. Rinse thoroughly with clear water. Do not
use fuel, kerosene, paint thinner, or other solvents to clean your
wiper blades. These will damage your blades.
*[MC24800(R)01/96]
To make reaching the wiper blades easy, simply turn the
ignition to the ACC position and turn your wipers on. Wait for
them to reach a vertical position and turn the ignition to the
OFF position. Do not move the wipers manually. Manually
moving the wipers across the windshield may damage them.
*[MC24900(R)02/96]
Wiper blade replacement
[MC25000(R)01/96]
If the wipers still do not work properly after you clean them,
you may need to replace the wiper blade assembly or the blade.
When replacing the wiper blade assembly, blade refill, or wiper
arm always use a Motorcraft part or equivalent.
*[MC25025(R)08/95]
To replace the wiper blades:
%
[MC25030(R)01/96]
Check the windshield wiper blades at least twice a year. Also
check them whenever they seem less effective than usual. Such
substances as tree sap and some hot wax treatments used by
commercial car washes reduce the effectiveness of wiper blades.
1. Cycle windshield wiper arm and wiper blade to where
removal of blade can be performed without difficulty. Turn
ignition off at desired position.
277
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC25075(R)01/96]
2. To remove wiper blade assembly from wiper mounting arm,
depress lock tab and push wiper mounting arm away from
wiper blade assembly.
[MC25100(R)01/96]
3. To install wiper blade assembly, pull wiper mounting arm
down on wiper blade until lock tab is engaged.
[MC25125(R)01/96]
24 pica art:0021371-A
Replacing the wiper blades
278
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC25200(R)01/96]
*[MC25300(R)03/96]
Tires
*[MC25400(R)02/96]
*[MC25500(R)02/96]
■ Use an accurate tire pressure gauge.
*[MC25600(R)03/96]
*[MC25700(R)03/96]
■ Make sure the weight of your load is evenly distributed.
*[MC25800(R)03/96]
If you do not take these precautions, your tires may fail or go
flat.
*[MC25890(R)03/96]
*[MC25900(R)03/96]
Ford Motor Company recommends obeying posted speed limits.
%
Look at your tires each time you fill your fuel tank. If one tire
looks lower than the others, check the pressure in all of them.
Always follow these precautions:
■ Check the tire pressure when tires are cold, after the vehicle
has been parked for at least one hour or has been driven less
than 3 miles (5 km).
■ Adjust tire pressure to recommended specifications found on
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.
WARNING
Driving too fast for conditions creates the possibility of
loss of vehicle control. Driving at very high speeds for
extended periods of time may result in damage to vehicle
components.
[MC26100(R)04/96]
At least once a month, check the pressure in all your vehicle’s
tires, including the spare. Use an accurate tire pressure gauge.
Check the tire pressure when tires are cold, that is, after the
vehicle has been parked for at least one hour or has been
driven less than 3 miles (5 km). You can find the proper cold
pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label.
279
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC26150(R)01/96]
WARNING
Improperly inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and
can fail suddenly, possibly resulting in loss of vehicle
control.
[MC26200(R)01/96]
Tire inspection and maintenance
*[MC26300(R)03/96]
Inspect the tire treads, and remove stones, nails, glass or other
objects that may be wedged in the tread grooves. Check for
holes or cuts that may permit air to leak from the tire, and
make the necessary repairs.
*[MC26400(R)03/96]
Inspect the tire side walls for cuts, bruises and other damage. If
you suspect internal damage to the tire, have it demounted and
checked. You may need to repair or replace it.
[MC26410(R)01/96]
Wheel inspection and maintenance
*[MC26420(R)03/96]
Check for damage that would affect the runout of the wheels.
Wobble or shimmy will eventually damage the wheel bearings.
*[MC26430(R)03/96]
Front wheel bearings require periodic repacking and adjustment
as specified in the Maintenance Schedule booklet. Loose or worn
front wheel bearings tend to let the vehicle wander or shimmy,
and can eventually cause excessive tire wear.
*[MC26435(R)03/96]
Whenever a wheel is removed and then re-installed, always
remove any corrosion that may be present on the mounting
surface of the wheel and/or the surface of the hub, drum or
rotor that contacts the wheel.
*[MC26440(R)03/96]
WARNING
Installing wheels without a good metal-to-metal contact at
the wheel mounting surface can cause the wheel lug nuts
to loosen and could allow the wheel to come off while
the vehicle is in motion.
280
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC26500(R)01/96]
*[MC26600(R)01/96]
Tire Rotation
*[MC26700(R)05/96]
For tire rotation intervals, see the Maintenance Schedule booklet.
If you notice that the tires wear unevenly, have them checked.
*[MC26750(R)03/96]
In situations where the tires differ from front to rear
(snow/traction), simply rotate using a side to side pattern.
%
Because your vehicle’s front and rear tires perform different
jobs, they often wear differently. To make sure your tires wear
evenly and last longer, rotate them as indicated in the following
diagram.
[MC26800(R)01/96]
17-1/2 pica
art:0021191-A
*[MC26900(R)03/96]
Tire rotation pattern
After each rotation, adjust individual tire pressure as specified
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. Tighten wheel lug
nuts to the required torque specification and retighten again
after 500 miles (800 km).
281
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC27000(R)03/96]
If your vehicle has aluminum wheels, you may demount the full
size, non-temporary spare tire (if so equipped) and remount on
an aluminum wheel to rotate the spare tire into your vehicle’s
rotation pattern. Rebalance the wheel.
*[MC27300(R)01/96]
*[MC27400(R)01/96]
Replacing the Tires
%
Replace any tires that show wear bands. When your tire shows
a wear band, it has only 1/16 inch (2 mm) of tread left.
*[MC27500(R)01/96]
7-1/2 pica art:0040200-A
A worn-out tire
*[MC27600(R)02/96]
Because your vehicle’s tires may wear unevenly, you may need
to replace them before a wear band appears across the entire
tread.
*[MC27700(R)03/96]
Your wheels and tires are match-mounted for improved ride.
Before you begin to repair a tire, mark the wheel and tire so
that they are properly aligned when remounted. This will
ensure that the tires will continue to give you the same ride
level.
282
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC27851(R)01/96]
WARNING
When replacing full size tires, never mix radial,
bias-belted, or bias-type tires. Use only the tire sizes that
are listed on the tire pressure decal. Make sure that all
tires are the same size, speed rating, and load-carrying
capacity. Use only the tire combinations recommended on
the decal. If you do not follow these precautions, your
vehicle may not drive properly and safely.
*[MC27860(R)03/96]
WARNING
Make sure that all replacement tires are of the same size,
type, load-carrying capacity, and tread design (e.g. “All
Terrain”, etc.), as originally offered by Ford.
[MC27866(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not replace your 4x2 tires with “high performance”
tires, or larger size tires than approved for your vehicle
by Ford.
283
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC27869(R)01/96]
Ranger 4x4 P235/265 Tire and Wheel Usage
[MC27870(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not use P235/75R15 “All Season” tires. For Ranger 4x4
Regular Cab vehicles, P235/75R15 “All Terrain” tires are
acceptable only on 15x7 inch wheels.
[MC27872(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not use P265/75R15SL tires on the Ranger 4x4 108
inch wheelbase. The P265/75R15SL “All Terrain” tires are
acceptable only on the 114 inch and 125 inch wheelbase
Ranger 4x4 models, and only with 15x7 inch wheels.
[MC27874(R)01/96]
six pica chart:0020904-C
*[MC27895(R)03/96]
WARNING
Failure to follow these precautions may adversely affect
the handling of the vehicle and make it easier to lose
control and roll over.
*[MC27900(R)01/96]
Tires that are larger or smaller than your vehicle’s original tires
may also affect the accuracy of your speedometer.
284
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC28600(R)01/96]
27-1/2 pica art:0020371-F
Tire identification chart
*[MC28700(R)03/96]
WARNING
Use of aftermarket wheel assemblies may damage your
vehicle or cause accidents resulting in serious injuries.
285
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC28800(R)03/96]
*[MC28950(R)03/96]
Wheel and Tire Matching
*[MC31100(R)01/96]
*[MC31200(R)03/96]
Snow Tires and Chains
%
%
See an authorized tire dealer for proper servicing procedures.
Wheels and tires must be properly removed, matched and
remounted to maintain the best possible ride.
The tires on your vehicle have all-weather treads that provide
traction in rain or snow. However, during the winter months in
some climates, you may need to use snow tires and occasionally
chains for your tires.
*[MC31300(R)01/96]
WARNING
Snow tires must be the same size and grade as the tires
you currently have on your vehicle.
*[MC31400(R)01/96]
Do not use chains when using a temporary spare. For full size
tires, use chains on the tires only in an emergency or if the law
requires them where you live. When you use the tire chains:
*[MC31500(R)01/96]
■ Make sure the chains are the right size for your tires. Use
*[MC31525(R)01/96]
■ Tire chains may scratch or chip aluminum wheels. IT IS
[MC31550(R)01/96]
■ Install tire chains on rear tires; use of chains on front tires is
only SAE Class “S” chains. Other types may damage your
vehicle.
RECOMMENDED THAT TIRE CHAINS ARE INSTALLED
ON STEEL WHEELS ONLY. Be sure to remove wheel
covers (if equipped) from steel rims before using tire chains
to avoid scratches or damage.
not recommended.
[MC31575(R)01/96]
■ Local regulations may prohibit or restrict the use of tire
chains. Investigate the laws and regulations in your area
before installing chains.
286
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC31600(R)01/96]
■ Put the chains on tightly with the ends held down securely.
*[MC31700(R)01/96]
■ Drive slowly. If you can hear the chains rub or bang against
*[MC31800(R)01/96]
*[MC31850(R)01/96]
■ Avoid fully loading your vehicle if possible.
[MC31900(R)01/96]
Remove tire chains at the first opportunity after using them on
snow and ice. Do not use the chains on dry roads.
*[MC31950(R)01/96]
■ Make sure your suspension insulation and bumpers are not
*[MC31960(R)03/96]
*[MC31970(R)03/96]
Cleaning the Wheels
*[MC31975(R)03/96]
NOTE: Before going to a car wash, find out if the brushes are
abrasive.
[MC31980(R)01/96]
If you have raised white letter tires that are difficult to clean
with regular detergent, use whitewall tire cleaner. Follow the
directions on the container and rinse the tires with plenty of
clean water.
%
Verify that no chain touches any wiring, brake lines, or fuel
lines. Follow the chain manufacturer’s instructions.
your vehicle, stop the vehicle and tighten the chains. If you
continue to hear the chains rub or bang against your vehicle,
remove the chains to prevent damage to your vehicle.
■ Tire chains may affect vehicle handling. Drive carefully and
avoid hard braking.
missing or worn to avoid damage to your vehicle.
Wash the wheels with the same detergent you use to wash your
vehicle’s body. Do not use acid-based wheel cleaners, steel wool,
abrasives, fuel, or strong detergents. These substances will
damage protective coatings. Use tar and road oil remover to
remove grease and tar.
287
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
%
*[MC32000(R)01/96]
Filling the Fuel Tank
[MC32150(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Fuel filler door
art:0020352-D
*[MC32200(R)01/96]
*[MC32220(R)01/96]
Opening the Fuel Filler Door
*[MC32230(R)02/96]
*[MC32250(R)01/96]
Filling the fuel tank
%
To open the fuel filler door of your vehicle, just insert your
finger in the divot and pull the door open all the way.
WARNING
Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray
and fire.
*[MC32300(R)01/96]
*[MC32310(R)01/96]
[MC32320(R)01/96]
To fill the fuel tank properly:
NOTE: Extinguish all lit cigarettes, other smoking materials,
and any open flames before fueling your vehicle.
1. Unscrew the fuel cap by exerting pressure on the plastic lock
bar and rotating the fuel cap counterclockwise.
[MC32330(R)01/96]
2. Turn the fuel cap 1/2 to 3/4 of a turn until a hissing sound
is heard. Wait until the hissing sound stops and then
continue rotating counterclockwise to remove the fuel cap.
288
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC32340(R)01/96]
[MC32350(R)01/96]
Make sure that you follow the above fuel cap removal
instructions and use caution. Such caution will minimize the
possibility of fuel spraying during removal of the fuel cap.
3. Make sure that you pump unleaded fuel and put the nozzle
all the way inside the fuel filler pipe.
[MC32360(R)01/96]
If you spill any fuel on the body of your vehicle, clean it off
immediately. The fuel may dull or soften the paint if you do
not wash it off.
*[MC32370(R)03/96]
To replace and secure the fuel cap, place it in position and
rotate it clockwise until it clicks (ratchets). Doing so will not
damage or break the fuel cap. The ratcheting mechanism allows
the fuel cap to be sealed without overtightening.
*[MC32380(R)01/96]
If you lose the fuel cap, replace it with an authorized Motorcraft
or equivalent part.
%
*[MC32400(R)01/96]
WARNING
If you do not use the proper fuel cap, the pressure in the
fuel tank can damage the fuel system or cause it to work
improperly in a collision.
*[MC32420(R)01/96]
*[MC32450(R)01/96]
NOTE: If you replace your fuel cap with an aftermarket fuel
filler cap, the customer warranty may be void for any
damage to the fuel tank and/or fuel system.
WARNING
The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel cap is
venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait until
it stops before completely removing the cap.
*[MC32500(R)01/96]
You may occasionally hear and/or feel a slight thump occurring
one or two seconds after a gentle stop. This is normal and
generally occurs with the fuel tank 3/4 full. It is caused by the
wave action of the fuel within the tank.
289
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC32510(R)01/96]
A venting fuel tank is not an abnormal condition. It may be
caused by:
[MC32520(R)01/96]
■ Too volatile a fuel for the weather conditions. The service
stations sometimes sell winter grade fuel in the spring.
*[MC32530(R)01/96]
*[MC32540(R)01/96]
■ Pulling a heavy load on hot days, or at high altitudes.
*[MC32550(R)01/96]
■ Parking vehicle in full sunlight for extended periods on
*[MC32580(R)01/96]
*[MC32592(R)05/96]
Choosing the Right Fuel
*[MC32600(R)05/96]
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel containing
manganese-based additives such as MMT. Additionally, vehicles
certified to California emission standards (indicated on the
underhood Vehicle Emissions Control Information label) are
designed to operate on California reformulated gasolines. If
California reformulated gasoline is not available when you
refuel, your vehicle can be operated on non-California fuels.
However, even though your engine will perform adequately on
other gasolines, the performance of the emission control devices
and systems may be adversely affected. Repair of damage
caused by using a fuel that your vehicle was not designed for
may not be covered by your warranty.
[MC32620(R)05/96]
Octane Recommendations
*[MC32640(R)05/96]
Your vehicle is designed to use regular gasoline with an
(R+M)/2 octane rating of 87. We do not recommend gasolines
labeled as “regular” in high altitude areas that are sold with
octane ratings of 86 or even less.
%
■ Extended periods of idling with the engine RPM increased
above the normal idle range.
extremely hot days.
Use only UNLEADED FUEL. The use of leaded fuel is
prohibited by law and could damage your vehicle. The damage
may not be covered by your warranty.
290
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC32660(R)05/96]
one inch art:0060001-C
Typical octane rating label
*[MC32680(R)05/96]
Do not be concerned if your vehicle sometimes knocks lightly.
However, if it knocks heavily under most driving conditions on
the recommended octane fuel, see your dealer or a qualified
service technician to prevent any engine damage.
[MC32700(R)05/96]
Fuel Quality
*[MC32720(R)05/96]
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation
problems, try a different brand of fuel. If the condition persists,
see your dealer or a qualified service technician.
*[MC32730(R)05/96]
The American Automobile Manufacturers Association (AAMA)
issued a gasoline specification to provide information on high
quality fuels that optimize the performance of your vehicle. We
recommend the use of gasolines that meet the AAMA
specification if they are available.
*[MC32740(R)05/96]
It should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to
your fuel tank if you continue to use a high-quality fuel.
[MC32742(R)05/96]
Cleaner Air
*[MC32744(R)05/96]
Ford approves the use of gasolines to improve air quality,
including reformulated gasolines, that contain oxygenates such
as a maximum of 10% ethanol or 15% MTBE. There should be
no more than 5% methanol with cosolvents and additives to
protect the fuel system.
291
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC32746(R)01/96]
*[MC32750(R)01/96]
%
Safety Information Relating to Automotive Fuels
WARNING
Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death if
misused or mishandled.
*[MC32760(R)01/96]
Gasoline and other automotive fuels are extremely flammable.
Turn your vehicle off and do not smoke while refueling your
vehicle. Keep sparks and other sources of ignition away from
fuels.
*[MC32762(R)01/96]
Automotive fuels can be harmful or fatal if swallowed. Further,
gasoline may be blended with methanol. Even small amounts of
methanol can cause blindness and possibly death when
swallowed. Therefore, never attempt to siphon any fuel by
mouth.
[MC32764(R)04/96]
If any fuel is swallowed, call a physician or poison control
center immediately. Do not delay calling a physician merely
because no adverse effects are noticed at first; the toxic effects
of fuels may not become apparent for many hours.
*[MC32766(R)01/96]
If gasoline is swallowed, do not induce vomiting. If a
gasoline-methanol blend is swallowed, induce vomiting under
the direction of a physician or poison control center.
*[MC32768(R)01/96]
Gasoline and gasoline-methanol blends may contain small
amounts of carcinogens, such as benzene. Long-term exposure to
unleaded gasoline vapors has caused cancer in laboratory
animals. Further, excessive inhalation of fuel vapors can cause
headache, dizziness, nausea, loss of coordination, and other
symptoms which could interfere with your ability to safely
operate your vehicle. To the extent possible, avoid breathing
vapors while refueling. If fuel vapors are inhaled in excessive
quantities, move the victim to fresh air and seek medical
attention.
292
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC32770(R)01/96]
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. When
refueling, be careful not to splash fuel on yourself or your
clothing. If fuel is splashed on the skin, promptly remove
contaminated clothing and wash the skin thoroughly with soap
and water.
*[MC32772(R)01/96]
Fuels can cause severe eye irritation and possibly eye damage. If
fuel is splashed in the eyes, remove contact lenses (if worn),
flush with large amounts of water for 15 minutes, and seek
medical attention.
*[MC32774(R)01/96]
If you are taking the medication “Antabuse” or other forms of
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism, vapor or skin contact
with a gasoline-methanol blend may cause the same kind of
adverse reaction as drinking an alcoholic beverage. In sensitive
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness could result.
Consult a physician promptly if you experience an adverse
reaction.
*[MC32800(R)01/96]
*[MC32810(R)01/96]
Running Out of Fuel
*[MC32812(R)01/96]
You may need to crank the engine several times before the fuel
system starts to pump fuel from the tank to the engine.
%
If your vehicle runs out of fuel, try to stop on level ground
away from traffic. Add at least two gallons (8 liters) of fuel to
start your vehicle again. If your vehicle is not on level ground,
you may need as much as five gallons (20 liters) of fuel to start
it.
293
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC32850(R)03/96]
*[MC32852(R)01/96]
Fuel Economy
*[MC32854(R)01/96]
*[MC32856(R)01/96]
To calculate fuel economy:
%
Fuel economy is an estimate of the efficiency of your vehicle
and can be calculated as Miles Per Gallon (MPG) or Liters Per
100 Kilometers (L/100K).
1. Fill the tank completely and record the initial odometer
reading.
*[MC32858(R)01/96]
2. Every time you buy fuel record the amount (in gallons or
*[MC32860(R)01/96]
3. After at least three to five tankfuls, fill the fuel tank and
*[MC32862(R)01/96]
4. Divide the total number of miles that you have driven by
%
*[MC32900(R)01/96]
liters) purchased.
record the final odometer reading.
the total number of gallons that your vehicle has used. In
metric, multiply the number of liters used by 100 and divide
the answer by the number of kilometers traveled. This will
give you the number of liters used per 100 km.
Comparisons With Environmental Protection Agency
(EPA) and Transport Canada (TC) Fuel Economy
Estimates
*[MC32950(R)05/96]
EPA fuel economy figures are obtained from laboratory tests
under simulated road conditions and may not reflect the actual
conditions you experience or your style of driving. The EPA
fuel economy estimate is not a guarantee that you will achieve
the fuel economy shown.
*[MC33000(R)01/96]
*[MC33010(R)01/96]
Improving Fuel Economy
%
Fuel economy is affected by a number of variables which can
reduce efficiency. You can improve fuel economy by
understanding these variables and minimizing their effect.
294
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC33020(R)01/96]
*[MC33030(R)01/96]
*[MC33040(R)01/96]
*[MC33050(R)01/96]
*[MC33060(R)01/96]
*[MC33070(R)01/96]
*[MC33072(R)01/96]
*[MC33074(R)01/96]
*[MC33076(R)01/96]
The following decrease fuel economy:
*[MC33078(R)01/96]
*[MC33080(R)01/96]
*[MC33090(R)01/96]
■ Underinflated tires
*[MC42000(R)01/96]
*[MC42100(R)01/96]
Emission Control System
*[MC42110(R)01/96]
To make sure that the catalytic converter and the other emission
control parts continue to work properly:
*[MC42120(R)01/96]
*[MC42130(R)01/96]
*[MC42132(R)01/96]
■ Use only unleaded fuel.
*[MC42134(R)03/96]
■ Have the services listed in your Maintenance Schedule booklet
%
■ Lack of regular, scheduled maintenance
■ Excessive speed
■ Rapid acceleration and excessive speed
■ Driving with your foot on the brake
■ Sudden stops
■ Extended engine idling
■ Using speed control in hilly terrain
■ Extended use of the A/C, defroster, rear window defroster
and other accessories
■ Heavy loads
■ Aftermarket add-ons such as bike, ski or luggage racks, bug
deflectors, etc.
Your vehicle is equipped with a catalytic converter which
enables your vehicle to comply with applicable exhaust emission
requirements.
■ Avoid running out of fuel.
■ Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving,
especially at high speeds.
performed according to the specified schedule.
295
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC42200(R)01/96]
WARNING
Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass or
other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up
the engine compartment and exhaust system, which can
start a fire.
*[MC42300(R)01/96]
WARNING
On vehicles without original equipment floor covering or
insulation, do not let passengers ride in your truck in a
manner that allows contact between skin and the metal
floor.
*[MC42400(R)01/96]
Watch for fluid leaks, strange odors, smoke, loss of oil pressure,
the charge warning light, the check engine light, or the
temperature warning light. These sometimes indicate that the
emission system is not working properly.
*[MC42410(R)01/96]
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or
engine. Changes that cause more unburned fuel to reach the
exhaust system can increase the temperature of the engine or
exhaust system.
*[MC42420(R)01/96]
By law, anyone who manufactures, repairs, services, sells, leases,
trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles is not permitted
to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent it
from working. In some of the United States and in Canada,
vehicle owners may be liable if their emission control device is
removed or is prevented from working.
*[MC42430(R)08/95]
Never use a metal exhaust collector when you service your
vehicle. If the metal collector contacts any of your vehicle’s
plastic trim or bumper parts they could melt or deform.
*[MC42440(R)01/96]
Do not drive your vehicle if it does not operate properly. See
your dealer if the engine runs on for more than five seconds
after you shut it off or if it misfires, surges, stalls, or backfires.
296
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
%
*[MC42450(R)01/96]
Information about your vehicle’s emission control system is on
the Vehicle Emission Control Information decal located on or
near the engine. This decal identifies engine displacement and
gives some tune-up specifications.
%
*[MC42460(R)03/96]
How to Prepare Your Vehicle for
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) Testing
*[MC42470(R)04/96]
In some localities it may become a legal requirement to pass an
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of the On-Board Diagnostic
(OBD) II system. If your check engine light is on, reference the
check engine light description under the Warning Lights and
Gauges section. Your vehicle may not pass an I/M test with the
check engine light on. If the vehicle’s powertrain system or its
battery has just been serviced, the OBD II system is reset to a
not ready for I/M testing condition. To prepare for I/M testing,
additional city and highway driving is necessary to complete the
check of the OBD II system.
*[MC43000(R)05/96]
The driving modes required to reach the ready condition consist
of a minimum of 30 minutes of city and highway driving as
described below:
[MC43100(R)03/96]
■ 20 minutes of driving in stop and go city-type traffic with at
least four (4) idle periods.
*[MC43200(R)03/96]
■ 10 minutes of driving on an expressway or highway
[MC43300(R)03/96]
Before completing the above driving modes, the engine must be
warmed up and operating temperature. Once started, the vehicle
must not be turned off during the above driving modes. If the
vehicle owner is unable to meet the I/M requirements by using
these driving patterns, an authorized service center can perform
a detailed OBD II Drive Cycle as it would any other type of
repair work.
297
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC44600(R)03/96]
*[MC44700(R)01/96]
Lights and Bulb Replacement
*[MC44800(R)01/96]
*[MC44850(R)01/96]
*[MC44900(R)01/96]
*[MC45000(R)01/96]
*[MC45100(R)01/96]
*[MC45200(R)01/96]
*[MC45300(R)05/96]
*[MC45350(R)01/96]
% [MC45400(R)01/96]
*
*[MC45500(R)01/96]
■ headlamps
*[MC45600(R)01/96]
■ the headlamps do not seem to give you enough light to see
*[MC45700(R)01/96]
■ the headlamp beams are pointed substantially away from a
%
It is a good idea to check the operation of the following lights
frequently:
■ high-mount brakelamp
■ tail lamps
■ brakelamps
■ hazard flasher
■ turn signals
■ license plate lamps
■ fog lamps
The alignment of your headlamps should be checked if:
■ oncoming motorists frequently signal you to turn off your
vehicle’s high beams when you do not have the high beams
on
clearly at night
position slightly down and to the right
298
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC45800(R)01/96]
*[MC45900(R)03/96]
%
Headlamp Bulb
The headlamps on your vehicle use replaceable bulbs. When the
lamp burns out, simply replace the bulb, rather than the whole
lamp.
*[MC46000(R)01/96]
WARNING
Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefully and keep out
of children’s reach. Grasp the bulb only by its plastic
base and do not touch the glass. The oil from your hand
could cause the bulb to break the next time the
headlamps are operated.
*[MC46050(R)01/96]
NOTE: If the bulb is accidently touched, it should be cleaned
with rubbing alcohol before being used.
*[MC46100(R)01/96]
Do not remove the burned-out bulb unless you can immediately
replace it with a new one. If a bulb is removed for an extended
period of time, contaminants may enter the headlamp housing
and affect its performance.
[MC46200(R)01/96]
10-1/2 pica
Parts of a headlamp
art:0021197-A
299
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC46300(R)03/96]
*[MC46400(R)01/96]
[MC46502(R)01/96]
Removing the headlamp bulb
1. Make sure that the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
2. Lift the hood. Remove the electrical connector behind the
headlamp by grasping the wires and pulling it rearward.
*[MC46700(R)01/96]
3. Remove the bulb retaining ring by turning it 1/8 of a turn to
*[MC46800(R)01/96]
4. Carefully remove the bulb assembly from its socket by
*[MC46900(R)03/96]
*[MC47000(R)01/96]
free it from the socket. Then slide the ring off the plastic
base. Keep the ring. You must use it again to hold the new
bulb in place.
gently pulling it rearward without turning.
Installing the headlamp bulb
1. With the flat side of the bulb’s plastic base facing upward,
insert the glass end of the bulb into the socket. You may
need to turn the bulb left or right to line up the grooves in
the plastic base with the tabs in the socket. When the
grooves are aligned, push the bulb into the socket until the
plastic base contacts the rear of the socket.
*[MC47100(R)01/96]
2. Slip the bulb retaining ring over the plastic base until it
*[MC47200(R)01/96]
3. Push the electrical connector into the rear of the plastic base
*[MC47300(R)01/96]
4. Turn the headlamps on and make sure that they work
contacts the rear of the socket. Lock the ring into the socket
by rotating it clockwise until you feel a “stop.”
until it snaps, locking it into position.
properly. If the headlamp was correctly aligned before you
changed the bulb, you should not need to align it again.
300
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
[MC47415(R)01/96]
Tail Lamp Bulb
[MC47420(R)01/96]
Removing the tail lamp bulb
[MC47425(R)01/96]
1. Remove the four (4) screws retaining rear lamp to vehicle.
[MC47430(R)01/96]
2. Remove rear lamp.
[MC47435(R)01/96]
3. Remove socket from lamp.
[MC47440(R)01/96]
4. Remove bulb from socket.
[MC47465(R)01/96]
Installing the tail lamp bulb
[MC47470(R)01/96]
1. Install tail lamp bulb in socket.
[MC47475(R)01/96]
2. Install socket to lamp.
[MC47480(R)01/96]
3. Install lamp to vehicle.
[MC47485(R)01/96]
4. Install four (4) lamp retaining screws.
301
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC47510(R)01/96]
24 pica art:0021369-A
Replacing the tail lamp bulb
302
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC47625(R)02/96]
Bulb Specifications
[MC48200(R)05/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0020414-M
303
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
[MC48400(R)04/96]
Rear lighting wire functions
[MC48500(R)05/96]
eight pica
chart:0021201-B
*[MC50000(R)04/96]
*[MC50010(R)01/96]
Cleaning Your Vehicle
*[MC50012(R)01/96]
Take similar precautions if your vehicle is exposed to chemical
industrial fallout.
*[MC50014(R)01/96]
Paint damage resulting from fallout is not related to a defect in
paint materials or workmanship and therefore is not covered by
warranty. Ford, however, believes that continual improvement
in customer satisfaction is a high priority. For this reason, Ford
has authorized its dealers to repair, at no charge to the owner,
the surfaces of new vehicles damaged by environmental fallout
within 12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) of purchase,
whichever comes first. Customers may be required to bring their
vehicle in for inspection by a Ford representative.
%
Pollen, bird droppings and tree sap can damage the paint,
especially in hot weather. Wash your vehicle as often as
necessary to keep it clean.
304
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC50030(R)01/96]
*[MC50032(R)01/96]
Washing and Polishing Your Vehicle
*[MC50034(R)01/96]
*[MC50036(R)01/96]
*[MC50038(R)01/96]
*[MC50040(R)01/96]
*[MC50042(R)01/96]
DO NOT:
*[MC50060(R)01/96]
*[MC50065(R)01/96]
Cleaning Chrome and Aluminum Parts
*[MC50100(R)01/96]
*[MC50110(R)01/96]
Cleaning Plastic Parts
*[MC50112(R)01/96]
Do not clean plastic parts with thinners, solvents or
petroleum-based cleaners.
%
%
%
%
*[MC50114(R)01/96]
*[MC50116(R)01/96]
%
*[MC50200(R)03/96]
Wash the outside of your vehicle, including the underside, with
a mild detergent.
■ Wash your vehicle with hot water
■ Wash your vehicle while it sits in direct sunlight
■ Wash your vehicle while the body is hot
Polish your vehicle to remove harmful deposits and protect the
finish.
Wash chrome and aluminum parts with a mild detergent. Do
not use steel wool, abrasive cleaners, fuel or strong detergents.
Some of your vehicle’s exterior trim parts are plastic. Clean with
a tar and road oil remover if necessary. Use a vinyl cleaner for
routine cleaning.
If you have your vehicle rustproofed, remove oversprayed
rustproofing with a tar and road oil remover. If rustproofing is
not removed from plastic and rubber parts, it can cause
deterioration.
Because your vehicle’s side mouldings are painted in lacquer, do
not use thinners or solvents to clean them.
NOTE: Any cleaner or polish that increases the gloss (shine)
of the upper part of the instrument panel should be
avoided. The dull finish in this area is to help protect
the driver from undesirable windshield reflection.
305
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC50500(R)01/96]
*[MC50510(R)01/96]
Cleaning the Exterior Lamps
*[MC51000(R)01/96]
*[MC51020(R)01/96]
Cleaning the Engine
*[MC51030(R)01/96]
■ Extreme care must be used if a power washer is used to
*[MC51040(R)04/96]
■ In order to avoid possible cracking of the engine block or
[MC51050(R)01/96]
■ The alternator, coils and air intake must be covered.
%
Do not use dry paper towel, chemical solvents or abrasive
cleaners to clean the lamps, as these may cause scratches or
crack the lamps.
A clean engine is more efficient because a buildup of grease and
dirt acts as an insulator, keeping the engine warmer than usual.
clean the engine. The high pressure fluid could penetrate
sealed parts and assemblies causing damage or malfunctions.
fuel injection pump, do not spray a hot engine or injection
pump with cold water.
Covering these components will help prevent water damage.
*[MC51060(R)01/96]
■ Never wash or rinse the engine while it is running. Water
*[MC51500(R)03/96]
% [MC51540(R)01/96]
*
*[MC51542(R)01/96]
Cleaning the Seats
*[MC51544(R)01/96]
NOTE: Before using any cleaner, test it on a small, hidden
area of fabric. If the fabric’s color or texture is
adversely affected by a particular cleaner, do not use
it.
%
getting into the engine may cause internal damage.
Fabric
Remove dust and loose dirt with a whisk broom or a vacuum
cleaner. Remove fresh spots immediately. Follow the directions
that come with the cleaner.
306
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC51560(R)01/96]
*[MC51562(R)01/96]
Leather
*[MC52000(R)02/96]
*[MC52020(R)02/96]
Cleaning the Safety Belts
*[MC52800(R)02/96]
*[MC52820(R)02/96]
Cleaning the Interior Lamps
*[MC56000(R)01/96]
*[MC56100(R)01/96]
*[MC56150(R)01/96]
Vehicle Storage
*[MC56200(R)01/96]
*[MC56300(R)01/96]
*[MC56400(R)01/96]
*[MC56500(R)01/96]
General
%
%
%
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth.
For more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a leather and
vinyl cleaner or a mild soap.
Clean the safety belts with any mild soap solution that is
recommended for cleaning upholstery or carpets. Do not bleach
or dye the belt webbing because this may weaken it.
Your interior dome lamps and map lamps are plastic and
should be cleaned with a mild detergent diluted in water. Rinse
them with clear water.
Maintenance Tips
If you plan on storing your vehicle for an extended period of
time (60 days or more), refer to the following maintenance
recommendations to ensure your vehicle stays in good operating
condition.
■ Store all vehicles in a dry, ventilated place.
■ Protect from sunlight, if possible.
■ If vehicles are stored outside, they require regular
maintenance to protect against rust and damage.
307
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
*[MC56600(R)01/96]
*[MC56700(R)01/96]
Body
*[MC56800(R)01/96]
*[MC56900(R)01/96]
*[MC57000(R)01/96]
■ Periodically wash vehicles stored in exposed locations.
*[MC57100(R)01/96]
■ Lubricate all hood, door and trunk lid hinges and latches
*[MC57200(R)01/96]
*[MC57300(R)01/96]
% [MC57350(R)01/96]
*
*[MC57400(R)01/96]
■ Cover interior soft trim to prevent fading.
*[MC57500(R)01/96]
■ With your foot on the brake, shift through all the gears
*[MC57600(R)01/96]
% [MC57700(R)01/96]
*
Fuel system
*[MC57900(R)01/96]
NOTE: During extended periods of vehicle storage (60 days or
more), fuel may deteriorate due to oxidation. This can
damage rubber and other polymers in the fuel system
and may also clog small orifices.
*[MC58000(R)01/96]
Ford Gas Stabilizer should be added whenever actual or
expected storage periods exceed 60 days. Follow the instructions
on the label. The vehicle should then be operated at idle speed
to circulate the additive throughout the fuel system.
%
■ Wash vehicle thoroughly to remove dirt, grease, oil, tar or
mud from exterior surfaces, rear wheel housing and
underside of front fenders.
■ Touch-up raw or primed metal to prevent rust.
■ Cover chrome and stainless steel parts with a thick coat of
auto wax to prevent discoloration. Re-wax as necessary when
the vehicle is washed.
with a light grade oil.
■ Keep all rubber parts free from oil and solvents.
Engine
■ Start engine every 15 days. Run at fast idle until it reaches
normal operating temperature.
while the engine is running.
■ Fill fuel tank with high-quality unleaded fuel until the first
automatic shutoff of the fuel pump nozzle.
308
File:11unmcr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:58:43 1997
Maintenance and Care
*[MC58100(R)01/96]
A volatile corrosion inhibitor added to the fuel system will
protect the fuel system’s inner surfaces from corrosion. Follow
the instructions packaged with the product.
*[MC58200(R)01/96]
*[MC58300(R)01/96]
% [MC58400(R)01/96]
*
*[MC58500(R)01/96]
*[MC58600(R)01/96]
Cooling system
*[MC58700(R)01/96]
*[MC58800(R)01/96]
% [MC58900(R)01/96]
*
*[MC59000(R)01/96]
*[MC59100(R)01/96]
*[MC59200(R)01/96]
Brakes
*[MC59300(R)01/96]
■ Move vehicles at least 25 feet (8 m) every 15 days to
%
%
■ Protect against freezing temperatures.
Battery
■ Check and recharge as necessary.
■ Keep connections clean and covered with a light coat of
grease.
■ Make sure brakes and parking brake are fully released.
Tires
■ Maintain recommended air pressure.
Miscellaneous
■ Make sure all linkages, cables, levers and clevis pins under
vehicle are covered with grease to prevent rust.
lubricate working parts and prevent corrosion.
309
File:12uncsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:59:10 1997
Capacities and Specifications
%
*[CS32800(R)01/96]
Motorcraft Parts
[CS33400(R)05/96]
twenty pica
chart:0090156-E
311
File:12uncsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:59:10 1997
*[CS51575(R)01/96]
Refill Capacities, Motorcraft Parts, and
Lubricant Specifications
[CS52750(R)05/96]
thirty pica
chart:0090219-C
312
File:12uncsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:59:10 1997
Capacities and Specifications
%
*[CS53500(R)01/96]
Lubricant Specifications
[CS55000(R)05/96]
thirty-two pica
chart:0090224-B
313
File:12uncsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:59:10 1997
[CS55100(R)05/96]
thirty pica
chart:0090225-B
314
File:13unrdr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 08:59:50 1997
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Only)
*[RD06307(R)03/96]
*[RD06308(R)03/96]
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Only)
*[RD06309(R)04/96]
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a
group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual
problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor Company.
*[RD06311(R)02/96]
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline
toll-free at 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 in the Washington, D.C.
area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation,
400 Seventh Street, Washington D.C. 20590. You can also obtain
other information about motor vehicle safety from the Hotline.
%
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause
a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.
315
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
Customer Assistance
*[HS00205(R)05/96]
*[HS00210(R)11/95]
Roadside Assistance
*[HS00215(R)06/94]
*[HS00220(R)06/94]
*[HS00225(R)06/94]
*[HS00230(R)06/94]
*[HS00235(R)06/94]
*[HS00240(R)06/94]
Roadside Assistance will cover the following:
*[HS00245(R)06/94]
*[HS00250(R)06/94]
How to use Roadside Assistance
*[HS00255(R)04/95]
To receive roadside assistance in the United States call
1-800-241-FORD (in Canada call 1-800-665-2006).
*[HS00260(R)04/95]
Should you need to arrange for roadside assistance yourself,
Ford Motor Company will reimburse the reasonable cost. To
obtain information about reimbursement call 1-800-241-FORD (in
Canada call 1-800-665-2006).
%
Ford Motor Company has set up a 24-hour, seven-day-a-week
hotline with trained operators who put you in touch with the
help you need if you experience a problem with your vehicle.
This complimentary service is provided to you throughout your
warranty period of 3 years or 36,000 miles (60,000 km),
whichever comes first. To purchase Roadside Assistance
coverages beyond this period (available through Ford Auto Club
in the United States or Ford and Lincoln-Mercury dealers in
Canada), contact your Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.
Additional Roadside Assistance coverage is unavailable in
Puerto Rico and the Virgin Islands.
■ Mount your spare if you have a flat tire.
■ Jump-start your battery if it is dead.
■ Unlock your vehicle if you are locked out.
■ Bring you fuel if you run out.
■ Tow your vehicle if you are stranded. Even non-warranty
related tows, like accidents or getting stuck in mud or snow,
are covered (some exclusions apply, such as impound towing
and repossession).
Your Roadside Assistance identification card can be found in the
Owner Guide portfolio in your glove compartment. Complete
the card and place it in your wallet for quick reference.
317
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
*[HS00300(R)01/95]
*[HS00400(R)01/95]
If You Have a Service Problem
*[HS00525(R)02/95]
*[HS00600(R)04/95]
Service/Maintenance Concerns (U.S. or Canada)
*[HS00700(R)04/95]
If you are not satisfied with the service you received from your
dealership’s service department, talk to the service manager at
the dealership, or if you still are not satisfied, talk to the owner
or general manager of the dealership. In most cases, you will
have your concern resolved at this level.
*[HS01000(R)04/95]
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs to be
serviced, or if you need more help than the dealer gave you,
contact the Ford Customer Assistance Center to find an
authorized dealership that may be able to help you.
*[HS01010(R)04/95]
Please have the following information available when contacting
Ford Customer Assistance:
*[HS01020(R)05/96]
*[HS01030(R)05/96]
■ your telephone number (both business and home)
*[HS01040(R)05/96]
*[HS01050(R)05/96]
*[HS01060(R)05/96]
% [HS01070(R)05/96]
*
■ the year and make of your vehicle
%
Ford Motor Company has authorized Ford and Lincoln-Mercury
dealerships that can service your vehicle for you. This chapter
tells you how to get service or maintenance for your vehicle.
Ford recommends taking your vehicle to your selling dealer
who wants to ensure your continued satisfaction. You may,
however, take your vehicle to any authorized Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealer. In most cases, your dealer will be able
to resolve your concern.
■ the name of the dealer and the city where the dealership is
located
■ the date purchased
■ the current mileage on your vehicle
■ your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) listed on your
vehicle ownership license
318
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
Customer Assistance
[HS01105(R)04/96]
In the United States, contact:
[HS01120(R)01/95]
6 pica art:0050105-A
[HS01130(R)03/95]
In Canada, contact:
[HS01135(R)05/95]
6 pica art:0040188-B
*[HS01160(R)05/96]
If you still have a complaint involving a warranty dispute, you
may wish to contact the Dispute Settlement Board (U.S. only) or
the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP) in
Canada.
*[HS01200(R)05/96]
A warranty dispute must be submitted to the Dispute
Settlement Board before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss
Warranty Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before
pursuing replacement or repurchase remedies provided by
certain state laws. This dispute handling procedure is not
required prior to enforcing state created rights or other rights
which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act or
state replacement or repurchase laws.
319
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
*[HS01300(R)05/96]
*[HS01400(R)05/96]
*[HS01500(R)05/96]
The Dispute Settlement Board (U.S. only)
*[HS01600(R)05/96]
■ available free to owners and lessees of qualifying Ford Motor
*[HS01700(R)05/96]
The Dispute Settlement Board may not be available in all states.
Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility
limitations, modify procedures and/or discontinue this service
without notice and without incurring obligations.
*[HS01800(R)05/96]
*[HS01900(R)05/96]
What Kinds of Cases Does the Board Review?
*[HS02000(R)05/96]
*[HS02100(R)05/96]
*[HS02200(R)05/96]
*[HS02300(R)05/96]
■ a non-Ford product
*[HS02400(R)05/96]
*[HS02500(R)05/96]
*[HS02600(R)05/96]
*[HS02700(R)05/96]
■ items not covered by the new vehicle limited warranty
%
The Dispute Settlement Board is:
■ an independent, third-party arbitration program for warranty
disputes
Company vehicles
The Board reviews all warranty performance complaints on
Ford, Mercury and Lincoln cars and Ford and Mercury light
trucks under the new vehicle limited warranty that have not
been resolved by either a dealer or Ford Motor Company,
except those involving:
■ a non-Ford dealership
■ a vehicle sales transaction
■ request for reimbursement of consequential expenses.
Expenses incidental to the warranty complaint being
reviewed are eligible for consideration
■ items covered by a service contract
■ alleged liability claims
■ property damage where the damage is significant when
compared to the economic loss alleged under the warranty
dispute
320
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
Customer Assistance
*[HS02800(R)05/96]
*[HS02900(R)05/96]
■ cases currently in litigation
*[HS03000(R)05/96]
Complaints involving vehicles in which applicable new vehicle
limited warranties have expired at receipt of your application
are not eligible. Eligibility may differ according to state law. For
example, see the unique brochures for California and Wisconsin
purchasers/lessees.
*[HS03100(R)05/96]
*[HS03200(R)05/96]
*[HS03300(R)05/96]
*[HS03400(R)05/96]
*[HS03500(R)05/96]
How does the Board Work?
*[HS03600(R)05/96]
*[HS03700(R)05/96]
What the Board needs
*[HS03800(R)05/96]
Your application is reviewed and, if it is determined to be
eligible, you will receive an acknowledgment indicating:
*[HS03900(R)05/96]
*[HS04000(R)05/96]
■ the file number assigned to your application
*[HS04100(R)05/96]
Your dealership and a Ford Motor Company representative are
asked to submit statements at this time.
■ vehicles not used primarily for family, personal or household
purposes (except in states where the Dispute Settlement
Board is required to review commercial vehicles)
The Board consists of:
■ three consumer representatives
■ a Ford or Lincoln/Mercury dealer
Consumer candidates for Board membership are recruited and
trained by an independent consulting firm. Dealers are chosen
because of their business leadership qualities.
To have your case reviewed you must complete the application
in the DSB brochure and mail it to the address provided on the
application form.
■ the toll-free phone number of the DSB’s independent
administrator
321
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
*[HS04200(R)05/96]
To review your case properly, the Board needs the following
information:
*[HS04300(R)05/96]
■ legible copies of all documents and maintenance or repair
*[HS04400(R)05/96]
■ the year, make, model and Vehicle Identification Number
*[HS04500(R)05/96]
*[HS04600(R)05/96]
*[HS04700(R)05/96]
*[HS04800(R)05/96]
*[HS04900(R)05/96]
■ the date of repair(s) and mileage at the time of occurrence(s)
*[HS05000(R)05/96]
■ the names (if known) of all the people you contacted at the
*[HS05100(R)05/96]
■ a description of the action you expect to resolve your
*[HS05200(R)05/96]
Should your case NOT qualify for review, a letter of explanation
will be mailed to you.
*[HS05300(R)05/96]
*[HS05400(R)05/96]
Oral presentations
*[HS05500(R)05/96]
*[HS05600(R)05/96]
Making a decision
orders relevant to the case
(VIN) listed on your vehicle ownership license
■ the current mileage
■ the name of the dealer who sold or serviced the vehicle
■ a brief description of your unresolved concern
■ a brief summary of the action taken with the dealer and
Ford Motor Company
dealership
concern
If the involved vehicle is within 36 months and 36,000 miles of
the warranty start date, you have the right to make an oral
presentation before the Board. Indicate your choice to do so on
the application. Oral presentations may also be requested by the
Board.
Board members will review all available information related to
the complaint, including oral presentations, if necessary. They
then arrive at a fair and impartial decision, decided by a simple
majority vote.
322
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
Customer Assistance
*[HS05700(R)05/96]
Because the Board usually meets only once a month, some cases
may take longer than 30 days to be reviewed. The Board makes
every effort to resolve each case within 40 days of receiving the
consumer application form.
*[HS05800(R)05/96]
After a case is reviewed, the Board mails you a decision letter.
The Board also provides a form on which to accept or reject the
Board’s decision. The decisions of the Board are binding on the
dealer and Ford, but not on consumers who may elect to pursue
other remedies available to them under state and federal law.
Decisions of the Board may be presented as evidence by any
party in subsequent legal proceedings that may be initiated,
where allowed by law.
*[HS05900(R)05/96]
*[HS06000(R)05/96]
To Request a DSB Brochure/Application
For a brochure/application, speak to your dealer or write to the
Board at the following address:
*[HS06100(R)05/96]
6 pica art:0040272-A
323
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
*[HS06315(R)05/95]
*[HS06320(R)08/95]
*[HS06325(R)03/95]
%
Ford of Canada Customer Assistance
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited
If you live in Canada and have any questions or concerns that
the dealership cannot answer, contact the Customer Assistance
Centre.
*[HS06326(R)06/95]
7-1/2 pica art:0050104-B
*[HS06327(R)05/96]
Please have the following information available when contacting
the Customer Assistance Centre:
*[HS06328(R)05/96]
*[HS06329(R)04/95]
■ your telephone number (both business and home)
*[HS06330(R)05/96]
*[HS06331(R)05/96]
*[HS06332(R)05/96]
■ the year and make of your vehicle
*[HS06333(R)04/95]
■ the current mileage on your vehicle.
■ your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) listed on your
owner card and/or your vehicle ownership license.
■ the date purchased
■ the name of the dealer and the city where the dealership is
located
324
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
Customer Assistance
*[HS06335(R)09/95]
*[HS06340(R)05/96]
Mediation/Arbitration Program (Canada only)
*[HS06345(R)05/96]
The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward and relatively
speedy alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other
efforts to produce a settlement have failed. This procedure is
without cost to you and is designed to eliminate the need for
lengthy and expensive legal proceedings.
*[HS06350(R)05/96]
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party Arbitrators
conduct hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an
informal environment. These impartial Arbitrators review the
positions of the parties, make decisions and, where appropriate,
render awards to resolve disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast,
fair and final as the arbitrator’s award is binding on both you
and Ford of Canada.
*[HS06355(R)05/96]
CAMVAP services are available in all territories and provinces,
except Quebec. For more information, without charge or
obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial Administrator directly
at 1-800-207-0685.
*[HS06400(R)05/96]
*[HS06500(R)05/96]
Getting Help Outside the U.S. and Canada
*[HS06600(R)06/95]
Officials at the embassy or consulate can tell you where to get
unleaded fuel. If you cannot get unleaded fuel or can get only
fuel with an anti-knock index that is lower than your vehicle
%
In those cases where you continue to feel that the efforts by
Ford and the dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service
concern have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in
an impartial third party mediation/arbitration program
administered by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan
(CAMVAP).
Before you export your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate to make sure local
regulations do not prevent you from registering your vehicle.
Officials at the embassy can also help you decide whether you
should import your vehicle to that country.
325
File:14unhsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:11 1997
needs, contact a district or owner relations office before you
leave the U.S. or Canada.
*[HS06700(R)05/96]
Use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without a proper conversion
may damage the effectiveness of your emissions control system
and may cause engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford
Motor Company is not responsible for any damage that is
caused by use of improper fuel.
*[HS06800(R)06/95]
You may also have difficulty importing your vehicle back into
the U.S. if you use leaded fuel.
*[HS06900(R)06/95]
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or
living in Central or South America, the Caribbean, or the
Middle East, contact the nearest Ford dealership. If the
dealership cannot help you, write to:
*[HS07000(R)10/95]
7-1/2 pica art:0040273-C
*[HS07100(R)06/95]
If you are in other foreign countries, contact the nearest Ford
dealership. If the dealership cannot help you, they can direct
you to the appropriate Ford affiliate office.
*[HS07200(R)06/95]
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate
outside of the U.S. or Canada, register your Vehicle
Identification Number and new address with Ford Motor
Company Export Operations.
326
File:15unacr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:30 1997
Accessories
*[AC00400(R)05/96]
*[AC00425(R)01/96]
Ford Accessories for Your Vehicle
Ford has many fine products available from your dealer to clean
your vehicle and protect its finishes. For best results, use the
following, or products of equivalent quality:
*[AC00450(R)05/95]
twelve pica
chart:0032382-B
*[AC00500(R)05/96]
A wide selection of accessories is available through your local
authorized dealer. These fine accessories have been engineered
specifically to fulfill your automotive needs. They are custom
designed to complement the style and aerodynamic appearance
of your Ford-built vehicle. In addition, each accessory is made
from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigid
engineering and safety specifications. That is why Ford brand
accessories are warranted for up to 12 months or 12,000 miles
(20,000 km), whichever comes first. See your dealer for complete
warranty information and accessory availability.
327
File:15unacr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:30 1997
*[AC00600(R)05/96]
Safety, Comfort, and Convenience
[AC01700(R)05/95]
thirty-two pica
chart:0020766-I
328
File:15unacr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:30 1997
Accessories
*[AC01900(R)05/96]
NOTE: When adding accessories, equipment, passengers, and
luggage to your vehicle, do not exceed the total
weight capacity of the vehicle or of the front or rear
axle (GVWR, GAWR as shown on the Safety
Compliance Certification Label). Consult your dealer
for specific weight information.
*[AC02000(R)05/96]
NOTE: The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) or
the Canadian Radio Telecommunications Commission
(CRTC) regulates the use of mobile communications
systems — such as two-way radios, telephones, and
theft alarms — that are equipped with radio
transmitters. Any such equipment installed in your
vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC regulations
and should be installed only by a qualified technician.
*[AC02100(R)05/96]
NOTE: Mobile communications systems may harm the
operation of your vehicle, particularly if they are not
properly designed for automotive use or are not
properly installed. For example, when operated, such
systems may cause the engine to stumble or stall. In
addition, such systems may themselves be damaged or
their operation affected by operating your vehicle.
(Citizens band [CB] transceivers, garage door openers,
and other transmitters whose power output is 5 watts
or less will not ordinarily affect your vehicle’s
operation.)
*[AC02200(R)05/96]
NOTE: Because we have no control over the installation,
design, or manufacture of such systems, Ford cannot
assume responsibility for any adverse effects or
damage that may result if you use this equipment.
329
File:15unacr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:00:30 1997
[AC02900(R)07/95]
thirty-two pica
chart:0040403-A
330
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI00015(R)05/95]
full page art:0090185-A
331
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI03000(R)05/95]
full page art:0090161-D
Front exterior view
332
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI03600(R)05/96]
full page art:0090109-D
Rear exterior view
333
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI04200(R)05/96]
full page art:0090111-E
Entrance view
334
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI04800(R)05/96]
full page art:0021045-F
Driver’s door
335
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI05400(R)05/96]
full page art:0090194-G
Instrument panel
336
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI06000(R)05/96]
full page art:0090103-F
Instrument cluster
337
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI06050(R)05/96]
full page art:0090104-F
Instrument cluster with tachometer
338
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI07400(R)11/95]
full page art:0090148-C
The 2.3L engine compartment
339
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI07500(R)11/95]
full page art:0090149-C
The 3.0L engine compartment
340
File:16unqir.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:33 1997
[QI07600(R)11/95]
full page art:0090150-C
The 4.0L engine compartment
341
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
A
Accessory position on the ignition. . . . . .
Additives, engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air bag supplemental restraint system
and child safety seats . . . . . . . . . .
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
driver air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
passenger air bag . . . . . . . . . . . .
proper seating . . . . . . . . . . . . .
service and information labels . . . . . .
tone generator . . . . . . . . . . . . .
wearing safety belts . . . . . . . . . . .
Air cleaner filter
location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Alarm, activating remote personal. . . . . .
Ambulance packages . . . . . . . . . . . .
Antenna, radio (see Electronic sound system).
Antifreeze (see Engine coolant) . . . . . . .
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
see also Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
warninig light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Anti-theft system
arming the system. . . . . . . . . . . .
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
disarming an untriggered system . . . . .
disarming a triggered system. . . . . . .
triggering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appeals (see Dispute settlement board) . . .
Assistance (see Customer assistance). . . . .
. . . . . . . 73
. . . . . . 257
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
122,
. .
122,
. . .
. .
. .
. .
. .
129,
. .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 253
. 311
. . 94
. . 5
27, 55
. 265
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
155
157
155
10
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
98
98
99
99
98
320
317
.
.
.
.
.
133
127
131
127
12
127
127
123
127
131
123
343
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Audio system (see Electronic sound system)
Autolamp system (see Headlamps) . . . .
Automatic transmission
fluid, adding . . . . . . . . . . . . .
fluid, checking . . . . . . . . . . . .
fluid, specification. . . . . . . . . . .
Axle
lubricant specifications. . . . . . . . .
traction lok . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
27
63
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
273
272
313
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
313
170
B
Basic vehicle warranty . . . . .
Battery
acid, treating emergencies . .
battery saver . . . . . . . .
charging system warning light
disconnecting . . . . . . . .
how to service . . . . . . .
jumping a disabled battery. .
maintenance-free . . . . . .
proper disposal, recycling . .
replacement, specifications . .
servicing . . . . . . . . . .
voltage gauge . . . . . . .
when storing your vehicle . .
Brake fluid
brake warning light . . . . .
checking and adding . . . .
description . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . .
Brakes
adjustment . . . . . . . . .
anti-lock . . . . . . . . . .
applying the brakes . . . . .
brake warning light . . . . .
fluid, checking and adding. .
fluid, refill capacities . . . .
fluid, specifications . . . . .
344
. . . . . . . . . . . . .
3
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
238, 275
. . 97
. . 15
.
241
.
274
.
237
.
274
.
275
.
311
.
274
15, 19
.
309
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 10
.
261
.
261
.
313
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
155
.
155
.
159
. . 10
.
261
.
261
.
313
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Brakes (continued)
front disc . . . . . . . .
if brakes do not grip well
master cylinder . . . . .
new brake linings . . . .
noise . . . . . . . . . .
parking . . . . . . . .
power braking . . . . .
rear anti-lock . . . . . .
servicing . . . . . . . .
stopping distances . . . .
trailer . . . . . . . . .
when storing your vehicle
Brake-shift interlock . . . .
Break-in period . . . . . .
Brights (high beams) . . . .
Bulbs, replacing
halogen . . . . . . . .
headlamps . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
155,
. .
. .
. .
158,
. .
. .
. .
. .
. . .
. . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
155
158
261
5
158
160
155
155
261
159
212
309
165
5
21
299
299
C
Canada, customer assistance . . . . . . . .
Canada, warranty information . . . . . . .
Carbon monoxide in exhaust . . . . . . . .
Car seats for children (see Child safety seats)
Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chains, tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing a tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Charging system gauge . . . . . . . . . .
Charging system warning light . . . . . . .
Child safety restraints
child safety belts . . . . . . . . . . . .
child safety seats . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 324
. . 3
. 152
. 133
. 295
. 286
. 227
. . 19
. . 15
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
144
133
345
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Child safety seats
and air bags . . . . . . . . . .
attaching with tether straps . . .
automatic locking mode (retractor)
in front seat . . . . . . . . . .
in rear outboard seat . . . . . .
in rear seat . . . . . . . . . . .
tether anchorage hardware. . . .
Chime
headlamps on . . . . . . . . .
key in ignition . . . . . . . . .
safety belt . . . . . . . . . . .
Circuit breakers, see also fuses . . .
Cleaning your vehicle
chrome and aluminum parts . . .
engine compartment. . . . . . .
exterior . . . . . . . . . . . .
exterior lamps . . . . . . . . .
fabric . . . . . . . . . . . . .
headlamps . . . . . . . . . . .
instrument panel . . . . . . . .
interior. . . . . . . . . . . . .
interior lamps . . . . . . . . .
mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . .
plastic parts . . . . . . . . . .
polishing . . . . . . . . . . . .
rustproofing . . . . . . . . . .
safety belts . . . . . . . . . . .
tail lamps . . . . . . . . . . .
upholstery and interior trim . . .
washing . . . . . . . . . . . .
waxing. . . . . . . . . . . . .
wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . .
346
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
114,
. .
. .
. .
. .
133
143
133
133
133
133
143
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 21
. . 21
. . 11
.
218
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
305
.
306
.
304
.
306
.
306
.
306
.
305
.
306
.
307
. . 86
.
305
.
305
.
305
.
307
.
306
.
306
.
304
.
305
.
287
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Climate control system . . . . . . . . . . .
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clutch
fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . .
operation while driving . . . . . . . . .
recommended shift speeds . . . . . . . .
shifting the gears . . . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cold engine starting . . . . . . . . . . . .
Combination lap and shoulder belts . . . . .
Controls
mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
power seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Convenience kit in cargo area. . . . . . . .
Coolant (see Engine coolant)
checking and adding . . . . . . . . . .
preparing for storage . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cooling fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Crankcase emission filter . . . . . . . . . .
Customer Assistance Centre, Ford of Canada .
. . . . . . . 64
. . . . . 34, 55
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
261,
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
110,
263
263
170
173
171
313
148
112
. . . . . . . 86
. . . . . . 109
. . . . . . 229
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 265
. 309
. 313
. . 22
. 265
. 250
. 311
. 324
D
Daytime running light system
Defects, reporting . . . . . .
Defrost, windshield . . . . .
Dipstick
automatic transmission fluid
engine oil . . . . . . . .
power steering fluid . . . .
Disabled vehicle (see Towing).
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
. . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 70
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 271,
. . .
. . .
. . .
273
258
268
242
347
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Doors
lubricant specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driveline universal joint and slip yoke . . . . . . . . .
Driving under special conditions, heavy load . . . . . .
313
271
187
E
Electrical system
fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
operating when the engine is off .
relays . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic sound system
accessory delay . . . . . . . . .
radio reception . . . . . . . . .
tuning the radio . . . . . . . .
warranty and service information.
Emergencies, roadside
assistance . . . . . . . . . . .
battery acid spills . . . . . . . .
fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
jump-starting . . . . . . . . . .
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Emergency brake (parking brake) . .
Emission control system
catalytic converter. . . . . . . .
emissions warranty . . . . . . .
Engine
check engine warning light . . .
does not start. . . . . . . . . .
fuel injected engine, starting . . .
fuel pump shut-off switch . . . .
preparing to start . . . . . . . .
service points . . . . . . . . . .
starting . . . . . . . . . . . .
starting after a collision . . . . .
storing your vehicle . . . . . . .
348
. . . . . . . . 218, 224
. . . . . . . . . . . 73
. . . . . . . . . .
225
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . .
. 29,
. . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
238,
. .
. .
. .
158,
73
55
46
58
317
277
292
237
242
160
. . . . . . . . . .
295
. . . . . . . . . 3, 295
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 14
.
149
.
147
.
150
.
147
.
253
.
148
.
150
.
307
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Engine block heater . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine coolant
checking and adding . . . . . . . . .
checking hoses . . . . . . . . . . . .
disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
preparing for storage . . . . . . . . .
proper solution . . . . . . . . . . . .
recovery reservoir . . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .
temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . .
Engine coolant temperature gauge
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine coolant temperature guage:electronic
Engine fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine:idle speed control . . . . . . . . .
Engine oil
changing oil and oil filter . . . . . . .
checking and adding . . . . . . . . .
dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . .
filter, specifications . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .
synthetic oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .
“break-in” oils . . . . . . . . . . . .
viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Entry system
illuminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exhaust fumes. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Extended Service Plan, Ford . . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
150
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . .
. . . .
250, 261,
. . . .
250, 261,
. . . .
. . . .
. . . . .
265
267
273
309
273
253
313
22
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 258,
. . . .
. . . .
250, 261,
. . . . .
. . . .
. . 257,
. . . .
. . . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 22
. . 22
. . 22
. 250
. 149
260
258
258
273
20
311
313
257
5
257
. . 97
. . 93
. 152
. . 4
349
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
F
Fan, engine fan, avoiding injury . . . . . . . .
Federal Communications Commission . . . . . .
Flashers, hazard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ford Extended Service Plan . . . . . . . . . .
Ford Motor Company of Canada . . . . . . . .
Ford of Canada Customer Assistance Centre . . .
Foreign registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Four-Wheel Drive vehicles
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
lever operated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
special driving instructions. . . . . . . . . .
special notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Four-wheeling with Ford supplement . . . . . .
French owner guides, how to obtain . . . . . .
Fuel
calculating fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . .
choosing the right fuel . . . . . . . . . . .
comparisons with EPA fuel economy estimates
filling your vehicle with fuel . . . . . . . . .
filter, specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .
fuel filler door release lever . . . . . . . . .
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
improving fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . .
octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
running out of fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . .
safety information relating to automotive fuels.
storing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . .
treating emergencies. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel cap
removing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
350
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
250
. . 57
.
217
.
227
. .
4
.
324
.
324
.
325
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
175
.
179
.
186
. .
5
. .
5
. .
3
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
294
.
290
.
294
.
288
.
311
.
288
. . 22
.
294
.
290
.
290
.
293
.
292
.
308
.
292
. . . .
. . . .
288
288
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Fuel filler door
override, manual . . .
remote release . . . .
Fuel filter, specifications .
Fuel gauge . . . . . . .
Fuel pump shut-off switch
engine does not start .
starting after a collision
Fuse panels
instrument panel . . .
power distribution box
Fuses
charts . . . . . . . .
checking and replacing
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
288
288
311
22
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
150
150
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
224
223
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 218, 224
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
G
Gas cap (see Fuel cap) . . . . . . .
Gas mileage (see Fuel economy) . .
Gasoline (see Fuel). . . . . . . . .
Gauges, Electronic
engine coolant temperature gauge
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
odometer . . . . . . . . . . . .
speedometer . . . . . . . . . .
Gauges, Mechanical
battery voltage gauge . . . . . .
charging system gauge. . . . . .
engine coolant temperature gauge
engine oil pressure gauge . . . .
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
odometer . . . . . . . . . . . .
speedometer . . . . . . . . . .
tachometer . . . . . . . . . . .
trip odometer . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . 288
. . . . . . . . 290, 294
. . . . . . . . . . 288
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
22
22
25
24
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
19
19
22
20
22
25
24
25
25
351
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
calculating . . . . . . . . . . . .
definition. . . . . . . . . . . . .
driving with a heavy load . . . . .
location . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gearshift
automatic operation . . . . . . . .
column-mounted . . . . . . . . .
floor-mounted . . . . . . . . . .
gearshift override . . . . . . . . .
locking the gearshift. . . . . . . .
positions . . . . . . . . . . . . .
shifting the gears . . . . . . . . .
shift-lock . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gearshift:shifting the gears . . . . . .
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
calculating . . . . . . . . . . . .
definition. . . . . . . . . . . . .
driving with a heavy load . . . . .
location . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
196
. 187, 194
. . .
187
. . .
194
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
196
. 187, 194
. . .
187
. . .
194
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
164,
164,
. .
164,
164
164
171
165
73
171
171
165
171
H
Hazard flashers . . . . .
Headlamps
aiming . . . . . . . .
checking alignment . .
cleaning . . . . . . .
daytime running lights
replacing bulbs . . . .
turning on and off . .
warning chime . . . .
High beams
indicator light . . . .
operation. . . . . . .
Hitch. . . . . . . . . .
352
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
217
.
298
.
298
.
306
. . 63
.
298
. . 61
. . 21
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
211
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Hood
latch location . . . . . .
lubrication specifications .
release lever . . . . . .
working under the hood .
Hoses, checking . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
251
313
251
250
267
. . . . . . . . .
318
I
Identification Number, Vehicle (VIN) .
Idle
relearning . . . . . . . . . . . .
speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition
chime . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
positions of the ignition . . . . . .
Indicator lights and chimes (see Lights)
Infant seats (see Safety seats) . . . . .
Instrument cluster, mechanical . . . .
Instrument panel
lighting up panel and interior . . .
registers . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interval wipers . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . 241, 250, 276
. . . . . . . . . 149
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . .
. . .
131,
. . .
21
73
7
133
10
. . . . . . . . . . 64
. . . . . . . . . . 64
. . . . . . . . . . 76
J
Jack
operation . . . . . . .
positioning . . . . . .
storage . . . . . . . .
Jump-starting your vehicle
attaching cables . . . .
disconnecting cables . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 230, 233
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 230, 233
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
239
241
353
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
K
Keys
key in ignition chime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
positions of the ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
stuck in lock position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21
73
73
L
Lamps
checking . . . . . . . . . . . . .
combination cargo and brakelamp .
daytime running light system . . .
hazard flashers . . . . . . . . . .
headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . .
illuminated entry system. . . . . .
instrument panel, dimming . . . .
interior lamps . . . . . . . . . .
replacing bulbs . . . . . . . . . .
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lane change indicator (see Turn signal)
Lights, warning and indicator
air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
charging system . . . . . . . . .
check engine . . . . . . . . . . .
engine oil pressure . . . . . . . .
hazard warning light . . . . . . .
high beam . . . . . . . . . . . .
oil pressure. . . . . . . . . . . .
overdrive off . . . . . . . . . . .
safety belt . . . . . . . . . . . .
service engine soon . . . . . . . .
turn signal indicator. . . . . . . .
Load limits
GAWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . .
354
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
298
72
63
217
. 61
. 97
. 64
61, 64
.
298
.
213
. . 75
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
12
10
15
14
20
217
21
20
14
11
14
75
187
187
191
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Lubricant specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lug nuts
standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
tightening sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
313
233
230
M
Maintenance schedule and record (see separate
Maintenance Schedule and Record booklet)
Maintenance (see Servicing). . . . . . . . . . .
Manual transmission
clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
fluid, checking and adding . . . . . . . . . .
lubricant specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
shifting gears . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
shift speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master cylinder, brakes. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mileage, calculating fuel economy . . . . . . . .
Mirrors
dual electric remote control . . . . . . . . .
side view mirrors (power) . . . . . . . . . .
Motorcraft parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . 3
. . . . 249
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
170
274
313
171
173
261
294
. . . . . 86
. . . . . 86
. . . . 311
N
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration . . . . . 315
New vehicle break-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
O
Octane rating . . .
Odometer
description . . .
trip odometer . .
Oil filter . . . . .
Oil (see Engine oil)
Oil viscosity. . . .
On-board diagnostic
Overdrive. . . . .
Overseas offices . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
290
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
(OBD
. . .
. . .
25
25
311
257
257
297
169
325
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
II) system
. . . . .
. . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . .
. . .
260,
. .
. .
. .
167,
. .
355
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
P
Panic alarm feature, remote entry system
Parking brake
operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parts (see Motorcraft Parts). . . . . . .
PCV valve, specifications . . . . . . . .
Power distribution box (see Fuses) . . .
Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . .
Power features
door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . .
mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power steering
dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
driving with power steering . . . . .
fluid, checking and adding. . . . . .
fluid, specifications . . . . . . . . .
servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Prop rod, hood . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
94
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
160
. . 10
.
311
.
311
.
223
. . 84
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 84
. . 86
.
109
. . 84
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
268
162
268
313
162
251
R
Radio (see Electronic sound systems) . . . .
Rear anti-lock brakes . . . . . . . . . . .
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear axle
lubricant specification . . . . . . . . . .
traction lok . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Regulations, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration . . . . . . . . . . .
Relays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
356
. . . . . . . 27
. . . . . .
155
. . . . . .
155
. . . . . .
313
. . . . . .
170
. . . . . . . 84
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
315
225
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Remote entry system
arming and disarming the anti-theft system
illuminated entry . . . . . . . . . . . .
locking/unlocking doors . . . . . . . . .
panic alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
replacement/additional transmitters . . . .
replacing the batteries . . . . . . . . . .
Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . .
Restraints, safety (see Safety restraints)
adult . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
infant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reverse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Roadside assistance . . . . . . . . . . . .
Roadside emergencies . . . . . . . . . . .
Rotating the tires . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
95
97
94
94
97
95
315
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
101,
. .
131,
. .
. .
. .
. .
110
131
133
166
317
217
281
. . .
. . .
. . .
fuels .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
110
212
315
292
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
S
Safety belts (see Safety restraints) . . . .
Safety chains, when towing a trailer . . .
Safety defects, reporting . . . . . . . .
Safety information relating to automotive
Safety restraints
adjusting the safety belts . . . . . . .
automatic locking mode . . . . . . .
automatic locking mode (retractor) . .
cleaning the safety belts . . . . . . .
extension assembly . . . . . . . . .
for adults. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
for children . . . . . . . . . . . . .
for infants . . . . . . . . . . . . .
for pregnant women. . . . . . . . .
lap and shoulder belts . . . . . . . .
maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
112, 115,
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. 131,
. 103,
. 110,
. . .
118
114
114
307
120
110
131
133
110
112
120
357
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Safety restraints (continued)
proper use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
warning light and chime. . . . . . . . .
Safety seats for children
and air bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
attaching with tether straps . . . . . . .
automatic locking mode (retractor) . . . .
in front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
in rear outboard . . . . . . . . . . . .
in rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
tether anchorage hardware. . . . . . . .
Seat belts (see Safety restraints) . . . . . . .
Seats
adjusting the seat, manual . . . . . . . .
adjusting the seats, power . . . . . . . .
child safety seats . . . . . . . . . . . .
cleaning upholstery . . . . . . . . . . .
reclining the seat . . . . . . . . . . . .
seatback release . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Serial number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Service concerns. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Servicing your vehicle
precautions when servicing . . . . . . .
servicing when you tow . . . . . . . . .
Shift-lock system . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shift positions (see Gearshift) . . . . . . . .
Shoulder and lap belts (see Safety restraints) .
Shoulder belts (see Safety restraints) . . . .
Side mirrors, adjusting . . . . . . . . . . .
Snowplowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow tires and chains . . . . . . . . . . .
358
. . . . . .
110
. . . . . .
120
. . . . . . . 11
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
114,
. .
. .
. .
. .
. .
133
143
133
133
133
133
143
110
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
101
109
133
306
101
101
318
318
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
. .
. .
164,
110,
112,
. . .
. .
. .
250
242
165
171
112
115
86
216
286
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Spare tire
changing the tire . . . . . . . . . . . . .
conventional spare . . . . . . . . . . . .
finding the spare . . . . . . . . . . . . .
removing the spare tire . . . . . . . . . .
storing the flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . .
temporary spare. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spark plugs, specifications . . . . . . . . . .
Special notice
E-4WD vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
four wheel drive vehicles . . . . . . . . .
Special Notice:four-wheel drive vehicles . . . .
Specification chart, lubricants . . . . . . . . .
Speed control
turning off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
when towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . .
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting your vehicle
preparing to start your vehicle . . . . . . .
starting a cold engine . . . . . . . . . . .
starting after a collision . . . . . . . . . .
starting a warm engine . . . . . . . . . .
starting your vehicle if the battery is disabled
Steering, power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering wheel
locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
tilting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Supplemental air bag readiness light . . . . .
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
227,
227,
. .
. .
229,
. .
. .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
230
229
229
229
233
227
311
. . 5
. . 5
. 186
. 313
. . . . . . 80
. . . . . 213
. . . . . . 24
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
147
148
150
148
237
162
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 73
. . 79
. 307
. . 12
. 122
359
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
T
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tail lamps
bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Temperature control (see Climate control) . . .
Tether anchor installation (see Child restraints).
Tilt steering wheel. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
checking the pressure . . . . . . . . . . .
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
inspection and maintenance . . . . . . . .
replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
rotating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
snow tires and chains . . . . . . . . . . .
spare tire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
storing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . .
tire grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
treadwear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
wear bands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
wheel and tire matching . . . . . . . . . .
Towing your vehicle
using wheel dollies . . . . . . . . . . . .
with a tow truck . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traction control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traction-lok rear axle . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer towing
calculating maximum trailer weight. . . . .
safety chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
trailer brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
trailer lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transfer case
fluid checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
lever operated . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
360
. . . . . .
82
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
242
242
170
170
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
196
212
212
213
. . . . .
. . . . .
274
179
.
.
.
.
.
.
298
.
306
. . 64
.
143
. . 79
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
227,
.
.
.
.
.
227
279
287
279
282
281
286
229
309
282
282
282
286
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Transmission
automatic operation . . . . . . . . .
fluid, checking and adding (automatic)
fluid, checking and adding (manual) .
lubricant specifications . . . . . . . .
Transmitter (see Remote entry) . . . . .
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tune-up specifications (VECI) . . . . . .
Turn signal
indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . .
lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 164
. 272
. 274
. 313
. . 93
. . 25
. 297
. . . . . . . . . 75
. . . . . . . . . 75
U
Used engine oil, disposal . . . . . . . . . . . .
250, 261, 273
V
Variable interval wipers . . . . . . . . . . . .
VECI (Vehicle Emission Control Information) decal
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). . . . . . .
Vehicle loading
calculating the load . . . . . . . . . . . . .
understanding loading information . . . . . .
Vehicle storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ventilating your vehicle (see Climate control) . .
Viscosity (see Engine oil) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Voltmeter (see Battery voltage gauge) . . . . . .
. . . . . 76
. . . . 297
. . . . 318
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 196
. 187
. 307
. . 64
. 257
15, 19
361
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
W
Warm engine, starting . . . . . . . .
Warning chimes
headlamps on . . . . . . . . . .
key in ignition . . . . . . . . . .
safety belt . . . . . . . . . . . .
Warning lights (see Lights) . . . . . .
Warranties
basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . .
radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Warranty Information Booklet . . . .
Washer fluid . . . . . . . . . . . .
Weight limits (GAWR, GVWR) . . . .
Wheel and tire matching . . . . . . .
Wheel bearings, lubricant specifications
Wheel dollies (see Towing) . . . . . .
Wheels
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . .
covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
inspection and maintenance . . . .
lug nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . .
replacement . . . . . . . . . . .
Windows
manual windows, operating . . . .
one-touch down . . . . . . . . .
power windows, operating. . . . .
362
. . . . . . . . .
148
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
21
21
11
7
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
3
3
58
3
76
187
286
313
242
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .
230,
. .
. .
. .
287
233
279
230
286
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
84
84
84
File:unixr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:44 1997
Index
Windshield
defrosting . . . . . . . . . . . .
washing . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield washer fluid and wipers
checking and replacing wiper blades
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .
reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . .
specifications . . . . . . . . . . .
variable interval wipers . . . . . .
Windshield wipers and washer . . . .
Wrecker towing . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . 67, 70
. . . . . . . . . . 76
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 277
. . . 76
. . 263
264, 313
. . . 76
. . . 76
. . 242
363
File:17ungsr.ex
Update:Thu Mar 20 09:01:53 1997
Service Station Information
[GS00300(R)05/96]
twenty-four pica
chart:0090146-F
364